Location via proxy:   [ UP ]  
[Report a bug]   [Manage cookies]                

Allison - CEC2 Trouble Shooting

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 243

CEC2 ELECTRONIC CONTROLS TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

PREFACE

Welcome to the TS3353EN Troubleshooting Manual. We make every effort to keep our service
information current and accurate. Because of the time lag involved with writing and printing processes,
the transmission TCM may report a code that has not yet been added to this document. If you encounter
a code that is not yet in this publication, please call the Allison Transmission Technical Assistance Center
at 1-800-252-5283.

Go to the Table of Contents.

Copyright© 2005 General Motors Corp.


Troubleshooting 2005 DECEMBER

Manual TS3353EN

Allison Transmission
5000, 6000, 8000, 9000 Series Transmissions
Commercial Electronic Controls 2 (CEC2)

M 5610A M 5610AR
S 5610H S 5610MR S 5610M
M 6610A M 6610AR
S 6610H S 6610HR S6610M S 6610MR
M 8610A M 8610AR
S 8610H S 8610HR S 8610M S 8610MR
M 9610A M 9610AR
S 9610A S 9610AR S 9610M S 9610MR
S 9805M S 9805MR
S 9810A S 9810AR S 9810H S 9810HR
S 9810M S 9810MR

Allison Transmission, General Motors Corporation


P.O. Box 894 Indianapolis, Indiana 46206-0894
www.allisontransmission.com

Printed in USA Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

FOREWORD—How to Use This Manual

This manual provides troubleshooting information for Allison Transmission (AT), 5000, 6000, 8000, and
9000 Series Off-Highway Transmissions which have CEC2. Service Manuals SM1866EN (5000, 6000),
SM1228EN (8000) and SM1833EN (9000), plus Parts Catalogs PC1860EN (5000, 6000), PC1249EN (8000), and
PC1830EN (9000) may be used in conjunction with this manual.
This manual includes:
• Description of the CEC2 system
• Description of the electronic control system components
• Description of diagnostic codes, system responses to faults, and troubleshooting
• Wire, terminal, and connector repair information.
Specific instructions for using many of the available or required service tools and equipment are not included in
this manual. The service tool manufacturer will furnish instructions for using the tools or equipment.
Additional information may be published from time to time in Service Information Letters (SIL) and will be
included in future revisions of this and other manuals. Please use these SILs to obtain up-to-date information
concerning Allison Transmission products.
This publication is revised periodically to include improvements, new models, special tools, and procedures. A
revision is indicated by a letter suffix added to the publication number. Check with your Allison Transmission
service outlet for the currently applicable publication. Additional copies of this publication may be purchased from
authorized Allison Transmission service outlets or from:
SGI, Inc.
Attn: Allison Literature Fulfillment Desk
8350 Allison Avenue
Indianapolis, IN 46268
TOLL FREE: 888-666-5799
INTERNATIONAL: 317-471-4995
Take time to review the Table of Contents and the manual. Reviewing the Table of Contents will aid you in quickly
locating information.
NOTE: Allison Transmission provides service of wiring harnesses and wiring harness components as follows:
• Repair parts for the internal wiring harness and for wiring harness components attached to the
shift selector will be available through the Allison Transmission Parts Distribution Center (PDC).
Use the P/N from your appropriate parts catalog or from Appendix C in this manual. Allison
Transmission is responsible for warranty on these parts.
• Repair parts for the external harnesses and external harness components must be obtained from
St. Clair Technologies Inc. (SCTI). SCTI provides parts to any Allison customer or OEM and is
responsible for warranty on these parts. SCTI recognizes AT, manufacturers, and SCTI part
numbers. SCTI provides a technical HELPLINE at 519-627-1673 (Wallaceburg). SCTI will have
parts catalogs available. The SCTI addresses and phone numbers for parts outlets are:

St. Clair Technologies, Inc St. Clair Technologies, Inc.


920 Old Glass Road Calle Damanti S/N Col
Wallaceburg, Ontario N8A 4L8 Guadalupe–Guaymas
Phone: 519-627-1673 Sonora, Mexico 85440
Fax: 519-627-4227 Phone: 011-526-2222-43834
Fax: 011-526-2222-43553

• St. Clair Technologies, Inc. stocks an external harness repair kit as a source for some external
harness repair parts. SCTI is the source for external harness repair parts.

ii Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

IMPORTANT SAFETY NOTICE

IT IS YOUR RESPONSIBILITY to be completely familiar with the warnings and cautions


used in this manual. These warnings and cautions advise against using specific service
procedures that can result in personal injury, equipment damage, or cause the equipment to
become unsafe. These warnings and cautions are not exhaustive. Allison Transmission could
not possibly know, evaluate, or advise the service trade of all conceivable procedures by which
service might be performed or of the possible hazardous consequences of each procedure.
Consequently, Allison Transmission has not undertaken any such broad evaluation.
Accordingly, ANYONE WHO USES A SERVICE PROCEDURE OR TOOL WHICH IS NOT
RECOMMENDED BY ALLISON TRANSMISSION MUST first be thoroughly satisfied
that neither personal safety nor equipment safety will be jeopardized by the service
procedures used.

Also, be sure to review and observe WARNINGS, CAUTIONS, and NOTES provided by the
vehicle manufacturer and/or body builder before servicing the Allison transmission in that
vehicle.

Proper service and repair is important to the safe and reliable operation of the equipment.
The service procedures recommended by Allison Transmission and described in this manual
are effective methods for performing troubleshooting operations. Some procedures require
using specially designed tools. Use special tools when and in the manner recommended.

The WARNINGS, CAUTIONS, and NOTES in this manual apply only to the Allison transmission
and not to other vehicle systems which may interact with the transmission. Be sure to review and
observe any vehicle system information provided by the vehicle manufacturer and/or body builder
at all times the Allison transmission is being serviced.

WARNINGS, CAUTIONS, AND NOTES


Three types of headings are used in this manual to attract your attention:

Is used when an operating procedure, practice, etc., which, if not correctly followed,
WARNING! could result in injury or loss of life.

Is used when an operating procedure, practice, etc., which, if not strictly observed, could
CAUTION: result in damage to or destruction of equipment.

NOTE: Is used when an operating procedure, practice, etc., is essential to highlight.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. iii


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

INTRODUCTION

TRADEMARKS USED IN THIS MANUAL

The following trademarks are the property of the companies indicated:

• LPS® Cleaner is a registered trademark of LPS Laboratories.

• Loctite® is a registered trademark of the Loctite Corporation.

• Teflon® is a registered trademark of the DuPont Corporation.

• Pro-Link® is a registered trademark of MicroProcessor Systems, Inc.

• Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is a trademark for General Motors Corporation

iv Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


CEC2 ELECTRONIC CONTROLS TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS

Page

Foreword. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . ii

SAFETY INFORMATION
Important Safety Notice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iii
Warnings, Cautions, and Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iii
Trademarks Used in This Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv

SECTION 1. GENERAL DESCRIPTION


1–1. TRANSMISSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–1
1–2. ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT (ECU) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–3
1–3. SHIFT SELECTOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–3
A. Pushbutton Shift Selector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–3
B. Lever Shift Selector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–4
1–4. THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–4
1–5. SPEED SENSORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–5
1–6. ELECTRO-HYDRAULIC VALVE COMPONENTS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–5
1–7. WIRING HARNESSES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–6
A. External Wiring Harness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–6
B. Internal Wiring Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–8
1–8. VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–9
1–9. AUTODETECT FEATURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1–9

SECTION 2. DEFINITIONS AND ABBREVIATIONS


2–1. CHECK TRANS LIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1
2–2. DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–1
2–3. ABBREVIATIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2–2

SECTION 3. BASIC KNOWLEDGE


3–1. BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–1
3–2. USING THE TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2
3–3. SYSTEM OVERVIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2
3–4. IMPORTANT INFORMATION IN THE TROUBLESHOOTING PROCESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–2
3–5. TESTING FOR OPENS, SHORTS BETWEEN WIRES, AND SHORTS-TO-GROUND . . . . . . . 3–3
3–6. TESTING AT TRANSMISSION CONNECTOR AND THE INTERNAL HARNESS
FOR OPENS, SHORTS BETWEEN WIRES, AND SHORTS-TO-GROUND . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3–5

SECTION 4. WIRE TESTING PROCEDURES


4–1. BEGINNING THE TROUBLESHOOTING PROCESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–1
4–2. GENERAL TROUBLESHOOTING OF PERFORMANCE COMPLAINTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–1
4–3. SHIFT INHIBITS—NO DIAGNOSTIC CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4–7

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. v


CEC2 ELECTRONIC CONTROLS TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
TABLE OF CONTENTS (C o n t ' d)

Page

SECTION 5. DIAGNOSTIC CODES


5–1. DIAGNOSTIC CODE MEMORY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–1
5–2. CODE READING AND CODE CLEARING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–1
5–3. DIAGNOSTIC CODE RESPONSE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–3
5–4. SHIFT SELECTOR DISPLAYS RELATED TO ACTIVE CODES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–3
5–5. DIAGNOSTIC CODE LIST AND DESCRIPTION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5–4

SECTION 6. VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)


6–1. ECU POWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–1
6–2. SYSTEM GROUNDS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–2
6–3. POWER AND GROUND USING A BUS BAR. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–3
6–4. INSTALLING A MASTER DISCONNECT SWITCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–4
6–5. IGNITION POWER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–5
6–6. CHECK TRANS LIGHT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–6
6–7. NEUTRAL START . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–7
6–8. SPEEDOMETER SIGNAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–8
6–9. REVERSE WARNING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–9
6–10. SHIFT SELECTOR/DISPLAY DIMMER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–10
6–11. SERIAL COMMUNICATION INTERFACE (SCI)—J1587/J1708. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–11
6–12. COMMUNICATION INTERFACE—SAE J1939 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6–12

SECTION 7. WIRING SCHEMATICS−OPTIONAL INPUT AND OUTPUT FUNCTIONS


7–1. CALIBRATION COMPATIBILITY. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7–2
7–2. INPUT FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7–3
7–3. OUTPUT FUNCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7–27

SECTION 8. CUTOMER MODIFIABLE CONSTANTS (CMC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8–1

APPENDICES
A. IDENTIFICATION OF POTENTIAL CIRCUIT PROBLEMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .A–1
B. WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . B–1
C. CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART NUMBERS,
TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–1
D. THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .D–1
E. WELDING ON VEHICLE/VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . E–1
F. HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . F–1
G. CEC2 WIRING SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .G–1
H. EXTERNALLY-GENERATED ELECTRONIC INTERFERENCE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .H–1
J. DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER INFORMATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . J–1

vi Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SECTION 1—GENERAL DESCRIPTION

1–1. TRANSMISSION
The Commercial Electronic Controls 2 (CEC2) system features clutch control to provide superior shift quality over
a wide range of operating conditions.

The ranges available in CEC2-equipped Off-Highway transmissions are as follows.


• 5610, 6610, 9610—six forward, neutral, two reverses
• 8610—six forward, neutral, reverse
• 9805—eight forward, neutral
• 9810—eight forward, neutral
Figure 1–1 is a block diagram of the basic transmission system inputs and outputs.

SHIFT SELECTOR
RANGE AND
MODE SWITCH DISPLAY

SPEED SENSORS
THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR SOLENOIDS
ECU
VEHICLE/ENGINE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
COMMUNICATION LINKS (SUMP)

VIM

INPUTS OUTPUTS V03469.01

Figure 1–1. Electronic Control Unit Block Diagram

Figure 1–2 shows the CEC2 electronic control components.

CEC2 consists of the following elements:


• Remote 12/24V Max Feature Sealed Electronic Control Unit (ECU)
• Remote Pushbutton or Lever Shift Selector
• Optional Secondary Shift Selector
• Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) (or electronic engine throttle data)
• Input, Turbine, and Output Speed Sensors
• Electro-Hydraulic Valve Bodies
• Wiring Harnesses
• Vehicle Interface Module (VIM)

NOTE: • All external harnesses are OEM supplied.


• The VIM is an OEM option.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 1–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

ELECTRONIC VEHICLE (V)


HARNESS

Y
CONTROL

A
R
G
UNIT
(ECU)
“V”

K
C
UE

LA
B
BL

TRANSMISSION (T) CONNECTOR


HARNESS (GRAY)
BL
UE
“T” VIW–V
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
SELECTOR (S) (BLUE)
HARNESS J 1939
CONNECTOR
PRO-LINK® (OPTIONAL)
DIAGNOSTIC
TOOL “S”
CONNECTOR
(BLACK)

TPS
ALLISON DOC™ FOR DIAGNOSTIC TOOL CONNECTOR
PC — SERVICE TOOL CONNECTOR (OPTIONAL)

VIW–S
CONNECTOR
VEHICLE
SCI (J 1587) INTERFACE
CONNECTOR MODULE
(OPTIONAL) (VIM)

REMOTE
LEVER TRIM
SELECTOR DEUTSCH
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL BOOST
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
VIM
(OPTIONAL) CONNECTORS

SHIFT TEMP SENSOR/


SELECTOR LOCKUP
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

OUTPUT
SPEED SENSOR
REMOTE CONNECTOR
PUSHBUTTON
SELECTOR THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR (TPS)
CONNECTOR
T
C
LE
SE

THROTTLE
E
D
O
M
R

POSITION
N
D

SENSOR (TPS)
TURBINE
SPEED SENSOR INPUT (ENGINE)
CONNECTOR TRANSMISSION
SPEED SENSOR MAIN VALVE
CONNECTOR BODY
CONNECTOR
Bulkhead Connector (Optional)

NOTE: Illustration is not to scale. Actual harness


configuration may differ from this illustration.
V06587.01.00

Figure 1–2. CEC2 Components

1–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

1–2. ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT (ECU)


The ECU (Figure 1–3) contains the microcomputer which is the brain of the control system. The ECU receives and
processes information defining:
• Shift selector position • Sump temperature • Turbine speed
• Throttle position • Input speed • Transmission output speed
The ECU uses the information to:
• Control transmission solenoids and valves.
• Supply system status.
• Provide diagnostic information.
Each ECU has a date code stamped on the label which is attached to the outer case of the ECU. This is the date
when the ECU passed final test. This date is commonly used to denote the change configuration level of the ECU.
It is normal for the ECU date displayed electronically to be a few days prior to the date shown on the label.

NOTE: ECU wiring harness connector retainers


are individually keyed and color-coded to
Y
A
R
G

make sure that the proper connector is attached


to the correct ECU socket. The color of the
connector retainer should match the color of
K
C

UE
LA
B

BL

the connector strain relief (see Appendix C,


UE
Paragraph C–1).
BL

ECU
V03352.00.02

Figure 1–3. Electronic Control Unit (ECU)

1–3. SHIFT SELECTOR


Pushbutton and lever shift selectors for CEC2 are remote mounted from the ECU and connected to the ECU by a
wiring harness. Both of these shift selectors have a single digit LED display and a mode indicator LED. During
normal transmission operation, illumination of the LED indicator shows that a secondary or special operating
condition has been selected by pressing the MODE button. During diagnostic display mode, illumination of the
LED indicator shows that the displayed diagnostic code is active. Display brightness is regulated by the same
vehicle potentiometer that controls dash light display brightness. More information on both types of shift selectors
is continued below.
A. Pushbutton Shift Selector (Figure 1–4)
The full-function pushbutton shift selector has a MODE button and diagnostic display capability
through the single digit LED display. The full-function pushbutton shift selector has the following
six (6) pushbuttons:
• R (Reverse) • D (Drive) • MODE
• N (Neutral) • ↓ (Down) and ↑ (Up) arrows

MODE ID

PUSHBUTTON R MODE

MODE INDICATOR (LED)


SELECTOR N
D

V06588.01.00

Figure 1–4. Typical Full-Function Pushbutton Shift Selector

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 1–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

Manual forward range downshifts and upshifts are made by pressing the ↓ (Down) and ↑ (Up) arrow buttons after
selecting D (Drive). The N (Neutral) button has a raised lip to aid in finding it by touch. The MODE button is
pressed to select a secondary or special operating condition, such as ECONOMY shift schedule. Diagnostic
information is obtained by pressing the ↑ (Up) and ↓ (Down) arrow buttons at the same time.

B. Lever Shift Selector (Figure 1–5)


The lever shift selector can have as many as six forward range positions, as well as two R (Reverse)
positions (R1 and R2) and N (Neutral). There is a hold override button which must be pressed and
held in order to move between certain selector positions. The hold override button must be pressed
when shifting between R, N, and D. The hold override button is released when the desired selector
position is reached. The selector lever can be moved freely between D and the numbered forward
ranges without pressing the hold override button. The lever selector can be chosen with the lever on
the left side or on the right side and with the R (Reverse) position toward the front or toward the rear
of the selector. Diagnostic information is obtained from the single digit LED display by pressing the
DISPLAY MODE button.

HOLD OVERRIDE BUTTON


MODE INDICATOR
(LED)
1 R
MODE MODE
2 N
3 D
4
MODE BUTTON 5
5 4
D MODE ID 3
N 2
R 1
DIGITAL DISPLAY
DISPLAY MODE/
DIAGNOSTIC BUTTON
SIX-SPEED, LEFT-HAND SIX-SPEED, RIGHT-HAND
LEVER SELECTOR LEVER SELECTOR
WITH REVERSE TO REAR WITH REVERSE TO FRONT V03355.02

Figure 1–5. Typical Lever Shift Selector

1–4. THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR (Figure 1–6)


The Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) can be mounted to the engine, chassis, or transmission. The TPS contains a pull
actuation cable and a potentiometer. One end of the cable is attached to the engine fuel lever and the other, inside a
protective housing, to the TPS potentiometer. Output voltage from the TPS is directed to the ECU through the
external harness. The voltage signal indicates the throttle position and, in combination with other input data,
determines shift timing.

A B
C

THROTTLE SENSOR

V00628

Figure 1–6. Throttle Position Sensor

1–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

1–5. SPEED SENSORS (Figure 1–7)


Three speed sensors—input speed, turbine speed, and output speed—provide information to the ECU. The input
speed signal is generated by the gear teeth on the top PTO gear. The turbine speed signal is generated by serrations
on the pitot can attached to the splitter low drum. The output speed signal is generated by a toothed member
attached to the output shaft. The speed ratios between the various speed sensors allow the ECU to determine if the
transmission is in the selected range. Hydraulic problems are detected by comparing the speed sensor information
for the current range to that range’s speed sensor information stored in the ECU memory.

FORMER (BEFORE JANUARY, 2006)

INPUT TURBINE OUTPUT


(EXTERNAL) (EXTERNAL) (EXTERNAL)

CURRENT (JANUARY, 2006)

INPUT TURBINE OUTPUT


(EXTERNAL) (EXTERNAL) (EXTERNAL)
V06589.01.00

Figure 1–7. Speed Sensors

1–6. ELECTRO-HYDRAULIC VALVE COMPONENTS (Figure 1–8)


The CEC2 electro-hydraulic valve bodies contain various solenoids to control the absence or presence of solenoid
pressure. Solenoid pressure, or lack of pressure, positions shift valves which apply or release transmission clutches
to produce the range commanded by the ECU inputs. The ECU is connected to the solenoids by a wiring harness
with sealed multi-pin twist-lock connectors at the control valve bodies.

MAIN CONNECTOR – ALL MODELS MAIN VALVE BODY


(SOLENOIDS A–G)
LOCKUP VALVE BODY
PLATE AND COVER CONNECTOR –
8610, 9610, 9805, 9810 MODELS
(SOLENOIDS H, I, AND J)

TRIM BOOST CONNECTOR – LOCKUP CONNECTOR – ALL MODELS


5610, 6610 MODELS (K SOLENOID AND SUMP
(SOLENOID J) TEMPERATURE SENSOR)

5/6/8/9000 SERIES OFF-HIGHWAY TRANSMISSION V06590.01.00

Figure 1–8. CEC2 Control Module

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 1–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

The sump temperature sensor in the lockup body sends information to the ECU. When oil temperature is below
–25ºF (–32ºC), all shifts are blocked. When oil temperature is between –25ºF * (–32ºC) and 20ºF * (–7ºC),
transmission shifting is limited to neutral, to limited forward ranges* , and reverse. Above 250ºF * (121ºC), the Hot
light comes on (if equipped), and a trouble code is stored in memory. Refer to chart in Section 5, Code 24 for sump
temperature sensor (thermistor) characteristics. Some applications (emergency vehicles, for example) are often
exempt from shift inhibit during temperature extremes, but the CHECK TRANS light may still come on and codes
may be logged in the ECU memory.

1–7. WIRING HARNESSES


A. External Wiring Harness (Figure 1–9)
CEC2 uses three external wiring harnesses to provide a connection between:
• ECU
• Transmission (including input, turbine, and output speed sensors)
• Throttle position sensor
• Vehicle interface module (VIM)
• Shift selectors
• Diagnostic tool connector
• Vehicle interface.
The transmission harness may include a bulkhead fitting to separate cab and chassis components.

NOTE: Allison Transmission provides service of wiring harnesses and wiring harness components as follows:

• Repair parts for internal wiring harness and wiring harness components attached to the shift
selector will be available through the Allison Transmission Parts Distribution Center (PDC). Use
the P/N from your appropriate parts catalog or from Appendix C in this manual. Allison
Transmission (AT) is responsible for warranty on these parts.
• Repair parts for external harnesses and external harness components must be obtained from
St. Clair Technologies Inc. (SCTI). SCTI provides parts to any Allison customer or OEM and is
responsible for warranty on these parts. SCTI recognizes AT, manufacturers, and SCTI part
numbers. SCTI provides a technical HELPLINE at 519-627-1673 (Wallaceburg). SCTI will have
parts catalogs available. The SCTI addresses and phone numbers for parts outlets are:

St. Clair Technologies, Inc St. Clair Technologies, Inc.


920 Old Glass Road Calle Damanti S/N Col
Wallaceburg, Ontario N8A 4L8 Guadalupe – Guaymas
Phone: 519-627-1673 Sonora, Mexico 85440
Fax: 519-627-4227 Phone: 011-526-2222-43834
Fax: 011-526-2222-43553

• St. Clair Technologies, Inc. stocks a CEC2 external harness repair kit, P/N 29532362, as a source
for some external harness repair parts. SCTI is the source for external harness repair parts.

* This is a programmed value subject to change.

1–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

VEHICLE (V)
HARNESS

“V” VIW–V
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
TRANSMISSION (T) (GRAY)
HARNESS
SELECTOR (S) “T”
HARNESS CONNECTOR
J 1939 (BLUE)
CONNECTOR
“S” (OPTIONAL)
CONNECTOR
(BLACK)

PRO-LINK®
DIAGNOSTIC TPS
TOOL VIW–S CONNECTOR
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR (OPTIONAL)

DEUTSCH
DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
CONNECTOR
(OPTIONAL)
VIM
ALLISON DOC™ FOR SCI (J 1587)
CONNECTORS
PC — SERVICE TOOL CONNECTOR
(OPTIONAL) TRIM
BOOST
CONNECTOR

SHIFT TEMP SENSOR/


SELECTOR LOCKUP
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR

ALLISON DOC™
FOR PC — SERVICE TOOL
OUTPUT
SPEED SENSOR
CONNECTOR

THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR (TPS)
CONNECTOR

TURBINE
SPEED SENSOR INPUT (ENGINE)
CONNECTOR TRANSMISSION
SPEED SENSOR MAIN VALVE
CONNECTOR BODY
Bulkhead Connector (Optional) CONNECTOR

NOTE: Illustration is not to scale. Actual harness


configuration may differ from this illustration.
V06591.01.00

Figure 1–9. CEC2 External Wiring Harnesses

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 1–7


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

B. Internal Wiring Harnesses (Figure 1–10)


The internal wiring harnesses provide connection between the external harness, solenoids, and the
temperature sensor.

INTERNAL
HARNESS

A
B

C
D

F
G
INTERNAL LOCKUP BODY
HARNESS ALL MODELS

MAIN BODY SOLENOIDS AND COVER


ALL MODELS

INTERNAL
HARNESS
INTERNAL
HARNESS

TRIM BOOST PLATE AND COVER


9610 MODEL FIRST OR LOW—LOW PLATE AND COVER
8610, 9810 MODEL

INTERNAL
HARNESS
J SOLENOID CONNECTOR

TRIM BOOST TRIMMER COVER


5610, 6610 MODEL VL06592.01.00

Figure 1–10. CEC2 Internal Wiring Harnesses

1–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

1–8. VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE (Figure 1–11)


The vehicle interface module (VIM) provides relays, fuses, and connection points to interface with the vehicle
electrical system. VIMs are available for both 12V and 24V electrical systems. The VIM for 12V systems uses all
12V relays. The VIM for 24V systems has all 24V relays. Refer to the parts catalog for the transmission assembly
number that you are servicing for detailed parts information. Refer to Pages B–19 and B–20 for VIM wire number
and terminal information. Further information is available in Appendix E.

Some OEMs may provide their own equivalent for the VIM which performs the same functions as the VIM shown
in Figure 1–11.

V00631.02

Figure 1–11. Vehicle Interface Module (VIM)

1–9. AUTODETECT FEATURE


Autodetect is active on the first 10* engine starts. Autodetect takes place within the first 5–25* seconds of each
engine start monitored. For CEC2, autodetect searches for the presence of a throttle information source. Autodetect
searches for a TPS (analog) source or a data link source via J1939 or J1587.

* This is a programmed value subject to change.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 1–9


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

GENERAL DESCRIPTION

NOTES

1–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SECTION 2—DEFINITIONS AND ABBREVIATIONS

2–1. CHECK TRANS LIGHT


When the ECU detects an abnormal condition, the CHECK TRANS light (usually located on the vehicle
instrument panel) illuminates and action is automatically taken to protect operator, vehicle, and transmission. A
diagnostic code will nearly always be registered when the CHECK TRANS light is on; however, not all diagnostic
codes will turn on the CHECK TRANS light. Codes related to the CHECK TRANS light are detailed in the code
chart (refer to Section 5).
Illumination of the CHECK TRANS light indicates that a condition was detected that requires service attention.
Operation of the transmission may or may not be restricted. Depending upon the cause for the CHECK TRANS
light illumination, the ECU may or may not respond to shift selector requests. The transmission may be locked in a
range. The range selected will flash on the shift selector display. Both upshifts and downshifts may be restricted
when the CHECK TRANS light is illuminated. Seek service assistance as soon as possible.
Each time the engine is started, the CHECK TRANS light illuminates briefly and then goes off. This momentary
lighting indicates the light circuit is working properly. If the light does not come on during engine start, request
service immediately.

2–2. DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER (Figure 2–1)


Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is the Allison Transmission preferred diagnostic tool. The Pro-Link® 9000
diagnostic tool can be used for limited support only. Addition information is available in Appendix J of this
manual.

PRO-LINK® 9000 DIAGNOSTIC TOOL ALLISON DOC™


FOR PC — SERVICE TOOL
V08849.00.01

Figure 2–1. Current Diagnostic Data Readers

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 2–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

DEFINITIONS AND ABBREVIATIONS

2–3. ABBREVIATIONS
A/N Assembly Number
Amp Unit of electrical current
AT Allison Transmission
CAN Controller Area Network—A network for all SAE J1939 communications in a vehicle
(engine, transmission, etc.)
CEC1/CEC2 Commercial Electronic Controls 1 or 2—Designation for electronic controls used in
off-highway and some older on-highway transmissions
COP Computer Operating Properly—Hardware protection which causes the ECU to reset if
software gets lost
CT Closed Throttle
DDU Digital Display Unit—Optional means of obtaining diagnostic information.
DNS DO NOT SHIFT—Refers to the DO NOT SHIFT diagnostic response during which the
CHECK TRANS light is illuminated and the transmission will not shift and will not
respond to the Shift Selector
DOC Diagnostic Optimized Connector
DVOM Digital volt/ohmmeter
ECU Electronic Control Unit (also commonly referred to as the “computer”)
GPI General Purpose Input—Input signal to the ECU to request a special operating mode or
condition
GPO General Purpose Output—Output signal from the ECU to control vehicle components
(such as PTOs, backup lights, etc.) or allow a special operating mode or condition
J1587 Engine/transmission serial data communications link
J1939 High-speed vehicle serial data communications link
LED Light-Emitting Diode—Electronic device used for illumination
NVL Neutral Very Low—The ECU has sensed turbine speed below 150 rpm when output speed
is below 100 rpm and engine speed is above 400 rpm when N (Neutral) was selected
OEM Original Equipment Manufacturer—Maker of vehicle or equipment
Ohm Unit of electrical resistance
PCCS PROM Calibration Configuration System
PCMCIA Personal Computer Memory Card International Association—Memory device for use
with Pro-Link® containing Allison Transmission programming and diagnostics
PROM Programmable Read Only Memory
PSS Primary Shift Selector—Main shift selector in a two-selector control system
PTO Power Takeoff
SCI Serial Communication Interface—Used to transmit data and messages between the
diagnostic tool and the ECU and other systems such as electronically-controlled engines

2–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

DEFINITIONS AND ABBREVIATIONS

2–3. ABBREVIATIONS (cont’d)


SOL OFF All SOLenoids OFF
SPI Serial Peripheral Interface—The means of communication between the microprocessor
and the interface circuits
SSS Secondary Shift Selector—Alternate shift selector in a two-selector control system
TPS Throttle Position Sensor—Potentiometer for signaling the position of the engine fuel
control lever
V Version—Abbreviation used in describing ECU software levels
V Volt—i.e., 24V
VDC Volts Direct Current (DC)
VIM Vehicle Interface Module—A watertight box containing relays and fuses—interfaces the
transmission electronic control system with components on the vehicle
VIW Vehicle Interface Wiring—Interfaces ECU programmed input and output functions with
the vehicle wiring
Volt Unit of electrical force
VOM Volt/ohmmeter
WOT Wide Open Throttle
∞ Infinity—Condition of a circuit with higher resistance than can be measured, effectively an
open circuit

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 2–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

DEFINITIONS AND ABBREVIATIONS

NOTES

2–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SECTION 3—BASIC KNOWLEDGE

3–1. BASIC KNOWLEDGE REQUIRED

To service CEC2, the technician must understand basic electrical concepts. Technicians need to know how to use a
volt/ohmmeter (VOM) to make resistance and continuity checks. Most troubleshooting checks consist of checking
resistance, continuity, and checking for shorts between wires and to ground. The technician should be able to use
jumper wires and breakout harnesses and connectors. Technicians unsure of making the required checks should ask
questions of experienced personnel or find instruction.

The technician should also have the mechanical aptitude required to connect pressure gauges or transducers to
identified pressure ports used in the troubleshooting process. Pressure tap locations and pressure values are shown
in the Service Manual for the transmission being checked.

Input power, ground, neutral start circuitry, etc., can cause problems with electronic controls or vehicle functioning
and may not generate a diagnostic code. A working knowledge of CEC2 vehicle installation is necessary in
troubleshooting installation-related problems.

Reliable transmission operation and performance depend upon a correctly installed transmission. Refer to
Section 4–3, Shift Inhibits, or Section 4–2, General Troubleshooting of Performance Complaints, for information
concerning performance complaints (non-code) troubleshooting. A complete wiring schematic is shown in
Appendix G. Refer to CEC2 Controls and Off-Highway Tech Data on the Allison Transmission extranet through an
Allison distributor, dealer, or OEM.

NOTE: Allison Transmission provides service of wiring harnesses and wiring harness components as follows:

• Repair parts for the internal wiring harness and wiring harness components attached to the shift
selector will be available through the Allison Transmission Parts Distribution Center (PDC). Use
the P/N from your appropriate parts catalog or from Appendix C in this manual. Allison
Transmission (AT) is responsible for warranty on these parts.
• Repair parts for the external harnesses and external harness components must be obtained from
St. Clair Technologies Inc. (SCTI). SCTI provides parts to any Allison customer or OEM and is
responsible for warranty on these parts. SCTI recognizes AT, manufacturers, and SCTI part
numbers. SCTI provides a technical HELPLINE at 519-627-1673 (Wallaceburg). SCTI will have
parts catalogs available. The SCTI addresses and phone numbers for parts outlets are:

St. Clair Technologies, Inc. St. Clair Technologies, Inc.


920 Old Glass Road Calle Damanti S/N Col
Wallaceburg, Ontario N8A 4L8 Guadalupe—Guaymas
Phone: 519-627-1673 Sonora, Mexico 85440
Fax: 519-627-4227 Phone: 011-526-2222-43834
Fax: 011-526-2222-43553

• St. Clair Technologies, Inc. stocks an external harness repair kit as a source for some external
harness repair parts. SCTI is the source for external harness repair parts.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 3–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

BASIC KNOWLEDGE
3–2. USING THE TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
Use this manual as an aid to troubleshooting CEC2. Every possible problem and its solution cannot be
encompassed by any manual. However, this manual does provide a starting point from which most problems can be
resolved.
3–3. SYSTEM OVERVIEW
CEC2 functions are controlled by the ECU. The ECU reads the following components to determine when to
command a shift:
• Shift selector range selection
• Output speed
• Throttle position.
When a shift occurs, the ECU monitors:
• Turbine speed
• Output speed
• Throttle position during the shift.
When the ECU detects an electrical fault, it logs a diagnostic code indicating the faulty circuit and may alter the
transmission operation to prevent or reduce damage.
When the ECU detects a non-electrical problem while trying to make a shift, the ECU may try that shift a second or
third time before setting a diagnostic code. Once that shift has been retried, and a fault is still detected, the ECU
sets a diagnostic code and holds the transmission in a lock-to-range mode of operation.

3–4. IMPORTANT INFORMATION IN THE TROUBLESHOOTING PROCESS


Before beginning the troubleshooting process, read and understand the following:
• CEC2 wire identification presents the wire number followed by the ECU terminal source (i.e., 157-S30). If
there is a letter suffix following the wire number, there is a splice between the ECU source and wire
destination (i.e., 116A-T19).
• Shut off the engine and ignition before any harness connectors are disconnected or connected.
• Remember to do the following when checking for shorts and opens:
— Shorts: Minimize movement of wiring harnesses when looking for shorts. Shorts involve wire-to-
wire or wire-to-ground contacts and moving the harnesses may eliminate the problem.
— Opens: Wiggle connectors, harnesses, and splices when looking for opens. This simulates vehicle
movements which occur during actual operation.
• When disconnecting a harness connector, be sure that pulling force is applied to the connector itself and
not the wires extending from the connector.
• Resistance checks involving the wiring between the ECU connectors and other components adds about
one Ohm of resistance to the component resistance shown.
• Inspect all connector terminals for damage. Terminals may have been bent or lost the necessary tension
to maintain firm contact.
• Clean dirty terminals or connectors with isopropyl alcohol and a cotton swab, or a good quality, non-
residue, non-lubricating, cleaning solvent such as LPS® Electro Contact Cleaner or LPS® NoFlash
Electro Contact Cleaner.

3–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

BASIC KNOWLEDGE

The cleaning solvent must not be chlorine based, contain petroleum distillates, or conduct
electricity. The cleaning solvent should evaporate quickly to prevent the possibility of
condensation within the connectors. Always blow or shake any excess cleaner from the
CAUTION:
connector before assembling it to its mating connector or hardware. Cleaner trapped in the
connector can affect the connector seal. Refer to SIL 17-TR-94 for detailed information
on the recommended cleaners.

Care should be taken when welding on a vehicle equipped with electronic controls. Refer
CAUTION:
to Appendix E, Paragraph 1–1.

• Diagnostic codes displayed after system power is turned on with a harness connector disconnected, can
be ignored and cleared from memory. Refer to Section 5, Diagnostic Codes, for the code clearing
procedure.

3–5. TESTING FOR OPENS, SHORTS BETWEEN WIRES, AND SHORTS-TO-GROUND


(Use Digital Volt/Ohmmeter J 34520-A and Jumper Wire Set J 39197)

NOTE: Please refer to Paragraph 4–1 to begin the troubleshooting process.

1. Make sure all connectors are tightly connected and re-test the circuit.
2. Disconnect and inspect all connectors.
3. Thoroughly clean corroded or dirty terminals. If dirty or corroded terminals are the probable cause of
the problems, reconnect the clean connectors and operate the vehicle normally. If the problem recurs,
proceed with Step (4).

The cleaning solvent must not be chlorine based, contain petroleum distillates, or
conduct electricity. The cleaning solvent should evaporate quickly to prevent the
possibility of condensation within the connectors. Always blow or shake any excess
CAUTION:
cleaner from the connector before assembling it to its mating connector or hardware.
Cleaner trapped in the connector can affect the connector seal. Refer to SIL 17-TR-94
for detailed information on the recommended cleaners.

4. Review the CEC2 wire numbering system described in Paragraph 3–4.


5. If all connectors are clean and connected correctly, determine which wires in the chassis harness are
indicated by the diagnostic code. For example, Code 45 12, indicates a failure in the F solenoid
circuit—wires 102-T1 and 120-T4.
a. Test continuity of wires 102-T1 and 120-T4 by performing the following (refer to Figure 3–1):
(1) Disconnect the blue “T” connector from the ECU and disconnect the harness from the
transmission main connector. At one end of the harness, using jumper wire kit J 39197 and
connector probes in J 39775-CP, connect wire 102-T1 and 120-T4 to each other, being careful
not to distort the terminals. Jumpering the wires together creates a circuit between wires
102-T1 and 120-T4.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 3–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

BASIC KNOWLEDGE

TRANSMISSION CONNECTOR

WIRING HARNESS
JUMPER
ECU
“T” CONNECTOR

0
VOLT/OHM-
— METER —
+ (VOM) +
0 OHMS OHMS
Circuit has continuity. Jumper Circuit does not have continuity due
from 102 or 120 to another wire to a broken wire (open circuit).
produces a complete circuit. VOM VOM reading is very high
reading is near zero Ohms. (infinite Ohms or OL – overlimit). V03374.01

Figure 3–1. Open Circuit

(2) On the opposite end of the harness, test the continuity of the jumpered pair. No continuity in a
jumpered pair circuit (infinite resistance reading) indicates an open in the wire being tested.
Locate and repair the damaged portion of the wire.
b. If the continuity test is good (0–2 Ohms resistance), remove the jumpers. Test the harness for
shorts between wires and shorts-to-ground by performing the following (refer to Figure 3–2):
(1) At the ECU end of the harness, touch one VOM probe to one wire of the circuit being tested
and touch the other probe to each terminal in the same connector, then touch the probe to chas-
sis ground and to the transmission main housing. Do this for both wires in the circuit being
tested.
(2) If at any time the VOM shows zero to low resistance, or the meter’s continuity beeper sounds,
there is a short between the two points being probed—wire-to-wire or wire-to-ground. Isolate
and repair the short.

3–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

BASIC KNOWLEDGE

TRANSMISSION CONNECTOR

WIRING HARNESS

ECU
“T” CONNECTOR
Wires shorted
together
Shorted to
ground on
metal frame
rail

Ground
to metal
frame rail
0 0
VOLT/OHM-
METER
— (VOM) —
+ +
0 OHMS 0 OHMS
Two wires have frayed and are shorted Harness has been chafed and one or more
together. Continuity beeper of VOM will wires are shorted-to-ground. VOM continuity
sound, or reading will go to zero Ohms beeper will sound, or reading will go to zero
when these two wires are probed with Ohms when meter is probing between this wire
the VOM. and chassis ground. V03375

Figure 3–2. Shorts Between Wires or to Ground

3–6. TESTING AT TRANSMISSION CONNECTOR AND THE INTERNAL HARNESS FOR


OPENS, SHORTS BETWEEN WIRES, AND SHORTS-TO-GROUND
1. Disconnect the external wiring harness from the transmission.
2. Inspect the connectors. Any terminals which are corroded or dirty must be thoroughly cleaned.

The cleaning solvent must not be chlorine based, contain petroleum distillates, or
conduct electricity. The cleaning solvent should evaporate quickly to prevent the
possibility of condensation within the connectors. Always blow or shake any excess
CAUTION:
cleaner from the connector before assembling it to its mating connector or hardware.
Cleaner trapped in the connector can affect the connector seal. Refer to SIL 17-TR-94
for detailed information on the recommended cleaners.

3. If the connectors are clean and connected correctly, determine which wires in the harness to test.
Use the diagnostic code system schematic to locate the wire terminals. For this example, Code 45 12
indicates a failure in the F solenoid circuit—wires 102-T1 and 120-T4 (refer to Figure 3–3 and 3–4).

NOTE: Resistance of all solenoids (except J on 5610, 6610 models only) should be 12–24 Ohms. Solenoid J
resistance on the 5610, 6610 should be 10–13 Ohms.

a. At the transmission main valve body connector, test for the resistance of the F solenoid circuit.
Resistance of the solenoid circuit should be 12–24 Ohms. No continuity in the circuit (infinite
resistance) indicates an open in the internal harness, the feedthrough connector, or the solenoid

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 3–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

BASIC KNOWLEDGE
coil. Locate and repair the open in the internal harness or replace the internal harness, replace the
feedthrough connector, or replace the solenoid.

MAIN VALVE BODY


CONNECTOR

18

— —
+ +

VOLT/OHM-METER
(VOM)
INFINITE ( ) OHMS
12-24 OHMS Circuit does not have continuity due to a
AT NORMAL OPERATING broken wire (open circuit). VOM reading is
TEMPERATURE* very high (infinite ohms or OL–overlimit).
Circuit has continuity. This could also be due to an open solenoid
* Refer to Appendix G coil or bad connection. V06593.01.00

Figure 3–3. Testing for Continuity

b. If the resistance test is good, test the harness for shorts between wires and to ground by performing
the following (refer to Figure 3–4):
(1) At the transmission connector, touch one probe of the VOM to one wire of the circuit being
tested and touch the other probe to each terminal in the connector and to chassis ground and
the transmission main housing. Do this for both wires in the circuit being tested.
(2) If the VOM shows zero to low resistance, or the continuity beeper sounds, there is a short
between the two points being probed, wire-to-wire or wire-to-ground. An indication of a short
may be caused by a splice to the wire being tested. Consult the wiring diagram in Appendix G
for splice locations. If the short is not a splice, then isolate and repair the short.

3–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

BASIC KNOWLEDGE

MAIN VALVE BODY


CONNECTOR

Shorted
Bare wires to metal
touching
each other

0
0


+

VOLT/OHM- +
METER
(VOM)
0 OHMS 0 OHMS
Two wires have frayed and are shorted Harness has been chafed and one or more
together. Continuity beeper of VOM will wires are shorted to ground. VOM continuity
sound, or reading will go to zero Ohms beeper will sound or meter reading will go
when these two wires are probed with to zero Ohms when meter is probing between
the VOM. this wire and chassis ground. V06594

Figure 3–4. Shorts Between Wires or to Ground

NOTE: When conducting circuit tests that include the external harness, add one (1) Ohm to the values shown.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 3–7


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

BASIC KNOWLEDGE

NOTES

3–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SECTION 4—TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT

4–1. BEGINNING THE TROUBLESHOOTING PROCESS


1. Begin troubleshooting by determining the transmission fluid level and ECU input voltage. Remember
that some problems may be temperature related. Do troubleshooting at the temperature level where
the problem occurs. Determine diagnostic codes by using:
• Shift selector display (refer to Paragraph 5–2 for code reading)
• Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool (Allison Transmission preferred diagnostic tool)
• Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool (limited support only)

2. When a problem exists but a diagnostic code is not indicated, refer to Section 4–3, Shift Inhibits, or
Section 4–2, General Troubleshooting of Performance Complaint, for a listing of various electrical and
hydraulic problems, their causes, and remedies.

3. If a diagnostic code is found in the ECU memory, record all available code information and clear the
active indicator (refer to Section 5).

4. Test drive the vehicle to confirm a diagnostic code or performance complaint.


• If the code reappears, refer to Section 5, Diagnostic Codes, and the appropriate code chart. The
Diagnostic Code section lists diagnostic codes and their description. Locate the appropriate
troubleshooting chart and follow the instructions.
• If the code does not reappear, it may be an intermittent problem. Use the Allison DOC™ For
PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool and Section 5, Paragraph 5–1. The code
display procedure will indicate the number of times the diagnostic code has occurred. Refer to
the troubleshooting chart for possible cause(s) of the problem.
• Appendix A deals with the identification of potential circuit problems. Refer to Appendix A if a
circuit problem is suspected.

NOTE: Information concerning specific items is contained in the appendices located in the back of this
manual. The appendices are referred to throughout the manual.

4–2. GENERAL TROUBLESHOOTING OF PERFORMANCE COMPLAINTS


IMPORTANT:

Determine the following before beginning specific troubleshooting, removing the transmission, or removing
attached components.

• Are there active diagnostic codes?


• Is the lever shift selector lever in N (Neutral) to allow starting the engine?
• Is the battery properly connected and charged?
• Have the items in Paragraph 4–1, been reviewed?
• Is the fluid level correct?
• Is voltage to the ECU correct?
• Is the engine properly tuned?
• Is fuel flow to the engine correct?

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 4–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT

• Is air flow to the cooler and radiator unrestricted?


• Is the driveline properly connected?
• Are there signs of fluid leakage under the vehicle? What is the origination point?
• Are hydraulic connections correctly made and not leaking?
• Is vehicle acceleration from a stop changed?
• Are electrical connections correctly made?
• Are there any other obvious vehicle or transmission problems?

Use the various sections of this manual to isolate the listed problems. The following charts address specific vehicle
complaints. Some complaints involve diagnostic codes, so all troubleshooting should involve determining if the
system has set any diagnostic codes.

Table 4–1. Troubleshooting Performance Complaints

Problem Probable Cause Suggested Remedy


SHIFT SELECTOR DISPLAYS No communication between the Refer to code 23 XX
“CATEYE” (-/-) AND VEHICLE ECU and a remote shift selector troubleshooting procedure
IS NOT OPERABLE
ECU interprets transmission not in Refer to code 56 XX
neutral troubleshooting procedure
SHIFT SELECTOR DISPLAY VIM Fuse is blown Replace VIM fuse
IS BLANK
Fuse blown in OEM substitute Replace fuse for VIM
Failed SDL (Serial Data Link) Should change to “cateye” within
12 seconds (refer to Code 23 16)
SHIFT SELECTOR NOT Wires 186, 187, or 188 are not Find wires 186, 187, and 188 and
LIGHTED AT NIGHT (WHEN connected or are improperly connect them or install wires, if
HEADLIGHTS ARE ON) connected. necessary.

4–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT


Table 4–1. Troubleshooting Performance Complaints (cont’d)

Problem Probable Cause Suggested Remedy


VEHICLE WILL NOT START Lever shift selector not in neutral Select N (Neutral) and restart
(ENGINE WILL NOT CRANK)
Dead battery Recharge battery
Disconnected battery Reconnect battery
Faulty starter circuit Repair vehicle starter circuit
Faulty neutral start relay Replace neutral start relay
Faulty wiring in neutral start circuit Repair wiring
Voltage to ECU too low Test battery and charging system
voltage. Refer to Code 13 12
troubleshooting procedure.
Faulty ignition wire (146) Repair wire 146
Faulty lever shift selector Replace lever shift selector. Refer to
Code 23 XX troubleshooting
procedure.
Lack of battery voltage on Circuit Repair Circuit 123 or replace
123 from ECU when in neutral the ECU
All display segments of display No calibration installed in ECU. Load Calibration
lighted Voltage to ECU too low Test battery and charging system
voltage. Refer to Code 35 00
troubleshooting procedure.
CHECK TRANS LIGHT WILL
NOT GO OUT AT START-UP
A. Vehicle Drives Normally Faulty CHECK TRANS relay or Replace relay or repair circuit
circuit.
Faulty wiring harness Repair harness
An LED rather than a lamp is Install a lamp rather than an LED
installed for the CHECK TRANS for the CHECK TRANS light
light and the LED is partially
lighted from leakage current
Faulty ECU Replace the ECU
B. Vehicle Does Not Drive Faulty harness Repair harness (refer to Section 4
and Appendix C)
Faulty interface wiring to vehicle Repair wiring (refer to Appendix C)
electrical system
Faulty ECU Replace the ECU

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 4–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT


Table 4–1. Troubleshooting Performance Complaints (cont’d)

Problem Probable Cause Suggested Remedy


CHECK TRANS LIGHT Intermittent power to ECU Determine input power to the ECU
FLASHES INTERMITTENTLY and correct if necessary
Loose CHECK TRANS relay Replace CHECK TRANS relay
Loose wiring to CHECK TRANS Repair wiring
light
Faulty or incorrect ground wire Repair ground circuit
attachment
Intermittent opening in Circuit 115 Repair Circuit 115
NO CHECK TRANS LIGHT AT Faulty light bulb or socket Replace light bulb or socket
IGNITION
Faulty relay Replace relay
Incorrect power to relay Test power line from ignition
switch to relay and repair
Incorrect wiring to and from Repair wiring (refer to Appendix C)
CHECK TRANS light bulb
Faulty wiring harness Test wiring between ECU and
CHECK TRANS light, and repair
where necessary (refer to
Appendix C)
Circuit 115 open Repair Circuit 115
Faulty ECU Replace the ECU
ECU WILL NOT TURN OFF Faulty ignition switch Replace ignition switch
WHEN IGNITION SWITCH OFF
Externally-generated speed sensor Find source of false speed sensor
signal(s) (refer to Appendix H for signal(s) and correct problem
detailed inspection)
TRANSMISSION WILL NOT Oil temperature too low Refer to Code 24 12
SHIFT TO FORWARD OR troubleshooting procedure.
REVERSE (STAYS IN
NEUTRAL) Throttle position sensor or linkage Refer to throttle position sensor for
is not functioning properly correct set-up (Appendix D). Refer
to Code 21 XX troubleshooting
procedure.
Voltage to ECU too low Test vehicle battery and charging
system. Refer to Code 13 12
troubleshooting procedure.
Shift selector is not functioning Replace shift selector. Refer to
properly Code 23 XX troubleshooting
procedure.

4–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT


Table 4–1. Troubleshooting Performance Complaints (cont’d)

Problem Probable Cause Suggested Remedy


TRANSMISSION WILL NOT Disconnected or dirty connectors Perform connector checkout (refer
SHIFT TO FORWARD OR to Appendix C)
REVERSE (STAYS IN
NEUTRAL) (cont’d) Faulty wiring harnesses Repair harness (refer to
Appendix C)
Speed sensor(s) not functioning Repair or replace speed sensor(s) or
properly circuitry (refer to Appendix C and
the appropriate transmission service
manual). Refer to Codes 22 XX and
25 XX troubleshooting procedures.
Faulty solenoid circuitry Refer to Codes 45 XX and 46 XX
troubleshooting procedures.
Faulty ECU Replace the ECU
Input function inhibit active Test input function programming
with Allison DOC™ or Pro-Link®.
Correct wiring.
TRANSMISSION WILL NOT Quick-to-neutral circuit (input Repair quick-to-neutral circuit
STAY IN FORWARD OR function) faulty
REVERSE
Leaking at solenoid assembly Rebuild solenoid assembly (refer to
appropriate transmission service
manual)
Faulty solenoid — leaking Replace solenoid (refer to
appropriate transmission service
manual)
TRANSMISSION WILL NOT Low engine power Correct engine problem, refer to
MAKE A SPECIFIC SHIFT engine service manual
Incorrect fluid level Correct fluid level
Extreme fluid temperature Inspect cooling system and fluid
level. Refer to Code 24 23
troubleshooting procedure.
Faulty speed sensor/circuit Repair circuit or replace speed
sensor(s). Refer to Code 25 XX
troubleshooting procedure.
Faulty solenoid circuitry Refer to Codes 45 XX and 46 XX
troubleshooting procedures.
Faulty temperature sensor/circuit Test for temperature reading which
inhibits shifts

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 4–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT


Table 4–1. Troubleshooting Performance Complaints (cont’d)

Problem Probable Cause Suggested Remedy


TRANSMISSION WILL NOT Incorrect calibration Install proper calibration
MAKE A SPECIFIC SHIFT
(cont’d) Faulty shift selector Replace shift selector. Refer to
Code 23 XX troubleshooting
procedure.
Hydraulic problem Refer to Range Clutch
Troubleshooting section
Faulty ECU Replace the ECU
TRANSMISSION DOES NOT Engine idle speed too fast (neutral Adjust engine idle speed (refer to
SHIFT PROPERLY (ROUGH to range shift) vehicle service manual)
SHIFTS, SHIFTS OCCURRING
AT TOO LOW OR TOO HIGH Faulty throttle sensor/circuit Refer to throttle sensor section for
SPEED) installation and operation
information (Appendix D). Refer to
Code 21 XX troubleshooting
procedure.
ECU input voltage low Test power, ground, charging
system, and battery function
Incorrect shift calibration for Install correct calibration
vehicle
Instrument panel tachometer Repair or replace tachometer
incorrect
Incorrectly calibrated electronic Calibrate electronic speedometer
speedometer
Faulty speed sensor/circuit Repair circuit or replace speed
sensor. Refer to Code 22 XX
troubleshooting procedure.
Loose speed sensor Tighten speed sensor retaining
bracket bolt
Incorrect fluid level Correct fluid level
Crossed wires in harness Test for crossed wires and correct
Intermittent problems Inspect and test wiring harnesses
and connectors (refer to Appendix
C)
Loose or damaged speed gear Tighten loose part or replace loose
part, if necessary

4–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT

Table 4–1. Troubleshooting Performance Complaints (cont’d)

Problem Probable Cause Suggested Remedy


TRANSMISSION DOES NOT Shift valve sticking Overhaul valve body assembly
SHIFT PROPERLY (ROUGH (refer to appropriate transmission
SHIFTS, SHIFTS OCCURRING service manual)
AT TOO LOW OR TOO HIGH
SPEED) (cont’d) Trimmer valves sticking Overhaul valve body assembly
(refer to appropriate transmission
service manual)
Faulty trim boost solenoid circuitry Refer to Code 45 21
troubleshooting procedure
Trim boost regulator sticking Overhaul valve body assembly
(refer to appropriate transmission
service manual)

4–3. SHIFT INHIBITS—NO DIAGNOSTIC CODES


Shift Inhibits are conditions present in the transmission that prevent shifting from taking place due to the state of
the transmission. The shift inhibits described below are not the result of any malfunction in the transmission or the
transmission’s control system. As such, no code will be related to these inhibits. Use Allison DOC™ For PC–
Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool to access the Shift Inhibits data screen in the Diagnostic menu.

1. INPUT SPEED N–>F INHIBIT (INPUT SPD N–>F)

If Input (engine) speed is above a calibration value, and the “SPLOGIC OUTPUT SPEED” is LO,
then neutral to drive shifts are allowed. This display updates from N to Y only after a forward range is
selected. It will update from Y to N when either the input speed falls below the calibration value or a
range other than forward is selected. This value is currently set too high to generate any indication
other than N.

2. INPUT SPEED N–>R INHIBIT (INPUT SPD N–>R)

If Input (engine) speed is above a calibration value, then neutral to reverse shifts are inhibited. This
display updates from N to Y instantly when the input speed exceeds a calibration value. It will update
from Y to N instantly when the input speed falls below the calibration value. This value is currently
set too high to generate any indication other than N.

3. SPECIAL FUNCTION RANGE INHIBIT (SPL FUNC RNG)

This inhibit is active (Y) when the Neutral to Range inhibit function is inhibiting shifts. INPUT wire
#137 is assigned for Neutral to Range Inhibit operation and is typically tied into the equipment Park
Brake System. If this wire is OFF, normal Neutral to Range shifts will not be inhibited by this
function. If this wire is ON, the shift selector LED window will flash R or 6, when the selector is
moved from Neutral to Reverse or Drive position, and no movement will occur. Determine from I/O
menu on Diagnostic Data Reader the state of wire 137. If wire 137 is ON, then the transmission will
not shift out of Neutral. Troubleshoot the wiring system to correct the problem.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 4–7


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT

4. MEDIUM COLD OIL INHIBIT (MED COLD OIL)

When the transmission oil is cold (–25ºF to 20ºF), this inhibit limits operation to Reverse, Neutral,
and 1st range, and the CHECK TRANS light, if available, is illuminated. This inhibit is not utilized
for emergency vehicle application.

5. WHEEL LOCK INHIBIT (WHEEL LOCK)

When the output shaft decelerates too rapidly, this inhibit will activate and prevent downshifts. This
condition only lasts for approximately 6 seconds. In addition, the lockup clutch, if applied at the time
of the rapid decel, will disengage and an alternate shift schedule will be utilized, which may
command the transmission to upshift.

6. SPLOGIC THROTTLE and SPLOGIC OUT SPD

SPLOGIC THROTTLE and SPLOGIC OUT SPD inhibitors identify the low (LO)–20 percent ON
and 17 percent OFF, and high (HI)–185 rpm ON and 180 rpm OFF, state condition of the Special
Pattern Logic.

7. SPECIAL PATTERN LOGIC (SPLOG)

Special Patten Logic is used to determine program actions or inhibits based on the transmission range
commanded, range selected, throttle position, and transmission output speed. This inhibit requires the
operator to command a range. Depending on the status of ‘SPLOGIC THROTTLE’ (LO/HI) and
‘SPLOGIC OUT SPD’ (LO/HI), the ‘SPECIAL PATTERN LOGIC’ will do one of the following:

• INHIBIT WARNING (INHIB WARN) Direction change shifts are inhibited and the shift select
range flashes. Look to SPLOGIC THROTTLE or SPLOGIC OUT SPD for HI state indication as
possible source of inhibit.
• COMMAND FORWARD NEUTRAL FORWARD REVERSE (CFNFR) CFNFR is used to
make sure the transmission is below a specific forward range before a shift to either Neutral or
Reverse is commanded. Whenever Neutral or Reverse is selected from a forward range, this logic
is applied. If the current range is greater than a calibration constant, CFNFR signals the ECU
which commands the preselect downshifts until the calibration range is attained, then Neutral is
commanded. If the current range is equal to or less than the calibration constant, the ECU will
command Neutral. Also, while this logic is applied, the selector digit will flash.
• NEUTRAL WARNING (NEUT WARN) The Transmission will shift to Neutral, and the selector
digit will flash.
• ENABLE SHIFTS (ENABLE SHIFT) This allows the selected direction change shift to be
commanded provided the shift is not already inhibited by one of the following direction change
inhibit features:
— Input speed Neutral to Range inhibit

— Direction change via Neutral Inhibit

— Any special input function direction change inhibit

4–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT

ADDITIONAL RANGE INHIBIT SCENARIOS


1. No Codes. No R. 1C/L only, regardless of selector forward range selection. R flashes and 1 in all for-
ward selector positions.
• Bed Hoist Interlock and Hold in Range features are both active. Both are used when the dump bed
is raised on end dump trucks. Test wire 177 via ‘I/O Wires’ diagnostic data menu. If the wire is
ON, Reverse will not be available. Test wire 163 via ‘I/O Wires’ diagnostic data option. If this wire
is ON, all forward range selector positions will show a 1 in the selector LED window, and 1st
converter and lockup are the only available ranges, unless engine speed attains Hold Override
speed, at which time a shift to 2nd higher ranges will occur.

2. No Codes. Won’t upshift except at high engine speed. No flashing indicator in shift selector LED
window.
• Delta (Δ) P Hold function is active. Test wire 117 via ‘I/O Wires’ diagnostic data option menu. If
the wire is ON, all upshifts are at the Hold Upshift engine rpm, not the normal full throttle upshift
rpm. NOTE: This function is temperature specific. Sump temperature must be at least 120˚F before
function is enabled.

3. No Codes. R and 1st available. Sometimes will shift to 2nd and even 3rd range, but not typically
above 3rd.
• Lockup not active. Compare engine rpm versus turbine rpm via ‘Diagnostic Data’ tools menu. If
not the same, or within 1 percent, not enough rpms available at Output Shaft to achieve the next
shift.
• If Sump Temperature is below 70°F or 100°F, depending upon calibration, Lockup will not be
available. Measure Sump Temperature via ‘Diagnostic Data’ diagnostic tools menu.
• If Automatic Lockup Off function is ON, lockup will not be available. Test wire 154 via ‘I/O
Wires’ diagnostic tools menu.
• Anti-lock brake function is active. Check wire 177.

4. No Codes. No R.
• SPLOGIC THROTTLE is HI. This will inhibit N to R shifts. Test TPS % via ‘Diagnostic Data’
diagnostic tools menu.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 4–9


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—NO CODES PRESENT

NOTES

4–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
SECTION 5—TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT

5–1. DIAGNOSTIC CODE MEMORY


Diagnostic codes are logged in a list in memory (sometimes referred to as the queue), listing the most recently
occurring code first and logging up to five codes. The codes contained in the list have information recorded as
shown in the table below (codes are examples). Access to the code list position, main code, subcode and active
indicator is through either the shift selector display, Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool, or the Pro-Link® 9000
diagnostic tool. Access to ignition cycle counter and event counter information is through either of the diagnostic
tools only. Further detail on the use of Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tools is
presented in Appendix J of this manual.

Table 5–1. Code List


Code List Ignition Cycle
Position Main Code Subcode Active Indicator Counter Event Counter
d1 21 12 YES 00 10
d2 45 12 YES 00 04
d3 23 12 YES 08 02
d4 34 12 YES 13 01
d5 56 11 YES 22 02
Displayed on shift selector and diagnostic tool
YES = LED indicator Not available on shift selector display
d = “diagnostic”
illuminated

The following paragraphs define the different parts of the code list.

A. Code List Position. The position which a code occupies in the code list. Positions are displayed as
“d1” through “d5” (Code List Position #1 through Code List Position #5).
B. Main Code. The general condition or area of fault detected by the ECU.
C. Subcode. The specific area or condition related to the main code in which a fault is detected.
D. Active Indicator. Indicates when a diagnostic code is active. The MODE indicator LED on the shift
selector is illuminated or the diagnostic tool displays YES.
E. Ignition Cycle Counter. Determines when inactive diagnostic codes are automatically cleared from
the code list. The counter is increased by one each time a normal ECU power down occurs (ignition
turned off). Inactive codes are cleared from the code list after the counter exceeds 25.
F. Event Counter. Counts the number of occurrences of a diagnostic code. If a code is already in the
code list and the code is again detected, that code is moved to position d1, the active indicator is
turned on, the Ignition Cycle Counter is cleared, and 1 is added to the Event Counter.
5–2. CODE READING AND CODE CLEARING
Diagnostic codes can be read and cleared by the following methods:
• Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool (Allison preferred diagnostic tool)
• Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool (limited support only)
• By entering the diagnostic display mode and using the shift selector display.
The use of Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool and Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool is described in the instruction
manual furnished with each tool or briefly in Appendix J of this manual. The method for reading and clearing codes
described in this section refers to entering the diagnostic display mode by the proper button movements on the shift
selector.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


The diagnostic display mode may be entered for viewing of codes at any speed. Active codes can only be cleared
when the output speed = 0 and no output speed sensor failure is active.

A. Reading Codes. Enter the diagnostic display mode by pressing the ↑ (Up) and ↓ (Down) arrow
buttons at the same time on a pushbutton selector, or by momentarily pressing the DISPLAY MODE
button on a lever shift selector.

NOTE: If a DO NOT SHIFT condition is present (CHECK TRANS light illuminated) at this time, the shift
selector may or may not respond to requested range changes.

The code list or queue position is the first item displayed, followed by the main code and the subcode. Each item is
displayed for about one second. The display cycles continuously until the next code list position is accessed by
pressing the MODE button. The following list represents the display cycle using code 25 11 as an example:

1. Code list position—d, 1


2. Main code—2, 5
3. Subcode —1, 1
4. Cycle repeats—d, 1, 2, 5, 1, 1
To view the second, third, fourth, and fifth positions (d2, d3, d4, and d5), momentarily press the MODE button as
explained above.

Momentarily press the MODE button after the fifth position is displayed to restart the sequence of code list
positions.

An active code is indicated by the illumination of the LED indicator when a code position is displayed while in the
diagnostic display mode.

Any code position which does not have a diagnostic code logged will display “–” for both the main and subcodes.
No diagnostic codes are logged after an empty code position.

B. Clearing Active Indicators. A diagnostic code’s active indicator can be cleared, which allows the
code inhibit to be cleared but remains in the queue as inactive.
The active indicator clearing methods are:

1. Power down—All active indicators, except code 69 34 (refer to the code chart), are cleared at ECU
power down.
2. Self-clearing—Some codes will clear their active indicator when the condition causing the code is
no longer detected by the ECU.
3. Manual—Some active indicators can be cleared manually, while in the diagnostic display mode,
after the condition causing the code is corrected.

If an active indicator is cleared while the transmission is locked in a forward range


CAUTION: (lock-to-range), the transmission will remain in the forward range after the clearing
procedure is completed. Neutral must be manually selected.

5–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


C. Manually Clearing Codes and Active Indicators from the Code List. To clear active indicators or
all codes:
1. Enter the diagnostic display mode.
2. Press and hold the MODE button for approximately three seconds until the LED indicator flashes.
All active indicators are cleared. To remove all inactive codes, press and hold the MODE button
for about ten seconds until the LED indicator flashes again. All active indicators will be cleared at
ECU power down.
3. Codes that cannot be manually cleared will remain.

D. Exiting the diagnostic display mode. Exit the diagnostic display mode using one of the following
procedures:
1. On a pushbutton shift selector, press the ↑ (Up) and ↓ (Down) arrow buttons at the same time or
press any range button, D, N, or R. The shift (D, N, or R) is commanded if not inhibited by an
active code.
2. On a lever shift selector, momentarily press the DISPLAY MODE button or move the shift lever to
any shift position other than the one it was in when the diagnostic display mode was activated. If the
shift is inhibited, the ECU will continue to command the current transmission range attained and the
lever should be returned to its original position.
3. Wait until timeout (approximately 10 minutes) and the system will automatically return to the
normal operating mode.
4. Turn off power to the ECU (turn off the vehicle engine at the ignition switch).

5–3. DIAGNOSTIC CODE RESPONSE

The following ECU responses to a fault provide for safe transmission operation:
• Do Not Shift (DNS) Response
— Release lockup clutch and inhibit lockup operation.
— Inhibit all shifts.
— Turn on the CHECK TRANS light.
— Shift selector display flashes the range selected.
— Ignore any range selection inputs from the pushbutton or lever shift selector.
• SOLenoid OFF (SOL OFF) Response
— All solenoids are commanded off.

5–4. SHIFT SELECTOR DISPLAYS RELATED TO ACTIVE CODES


• “Cateye”—The forward slash segments and the middle horizontal segments (-/-) may be on under the
following conditions:
— RSI link fault is active (code 23 12 or 23 14)
— Shift selector display line fault is active (23 16)
— When two COP timeouts occur within two seconds of each other (reference code 69 33)
— Range verification ratio test–Neutral (56 99)

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


• All Segments Displayed—All display segments will be illuminated if a severity 1 diagnostic code is
present during initialization, or if an electrical code for any solenoid is logged before initialization
completes.

5–5. DIAGNOSTIC CODE LIST AND DESCRIPTION


Table 5–2. CEC2 Diagnostic Codes

CHECK
Sub- TRAN
Main Code code Description Light Inhibited Operation Description
13 12 ECU input voltage, low Yes DNS
(pg 5–12)
23 ECU input voltage, high Yes DNS
21 12 Throttle position sensor, failed low Yes Use throttle default values
(pg 5–16)
23 Throttle position sensor, failed high Yes Use throttle default values
22 14 Engine speed sensor reasonableness Yes Use default engine speed
(pg 5–20) test
15 Turbine speed sensor reasonableness Yes DNS, lock in current range
test
16 Output speed sensor reasonableness Yes DNS, lock in current range
test
23 12 Primary shift selector or RSI link fault Yes Hold in last valid direction. May cause
(pg 5–24) “cateye” (-/-) display.
13 Primary shift selector mode function No Mode change not permitted
fault
14 Secondary shift selector or RSI link Yes Hold in last valid direction. May cause
fault “cateye” (-/-) display.
15 Secondary shift selector mode No Mode change not permitted
function fault
16 Shift Selector display line fault Yes None. May cause “cateye” (-/-) display.
24 12 Sump fluid temperature, cold Yes DNS, lock-to-range
(pg 5–26)
23 Sump fluid temperature, hot Yes No upshifts above a calibration range
25 11 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (1st)
(pg 5–30) 0 output rpm, 1st
22 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (2nd)
0 output rpm, 2nd
33 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (3rd)
0 output rpm, 3rd
44 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (4th)
0 output rpm, 4th

5–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


Table 5–2. CEC2 Diagnostic Codes (cont’d)

CHECK
Sub- TRAN
Main Code code Description Light Inhibited Operation Description
25 (cont’d) 55 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (5th)
0 output rpm, 5th
66 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (6th)
0 output rpm, 6th
77 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (7th)
0 output rpm, 7th
88 Output speed sensor, detected at Yes DNS, lock in current range (8th)
0 output rpm, 8th
26 00 Throttle source not detected No Use throttle default values
(pg 5–33)
33 12 Sump fluid temperature sensor failed Yes Use default value of 93˚C (200˚F)
(pg 5–34) low
23 Sump fluid temperature sensor failed Yes Use default value of 93˚C (200˚F)
high
34 12 Factory calibration compatibility Yes DNS, SOL OFF
(pg 5–37) number wrong
13 Factory calibration fault Yes DNS, SOL OFF
14 Power off fault Yes Use previous location, or factory
calibration
15 Diagnostic queue fault Yes Use previous location, or clear diagnostic
queue
16 Real time fault Yes DNS, SOL OFF
17 Customer modifiable constants fault Yes DNS, SOL OFF
35 00 Power interruption (code set after No None (hydraulic default during
(pg 5–38) power restored) interruption)
16 Real time write interruption Yes DNS, SOL OFF
36 00 Hardware/software not compatible Yes DNS, SOL OFF
(pg 5–41)
45 12 General solenoid failure—F Yes DNS
(pg 5–42)
13 General solenoid failure—K Yes DNS, Inhibit lockup
14 General solenoid failure—B Yes DNS, Inhibit Reverse
15 General solenoid failure—G Yes DNS

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


Table 5–2. CEC2 Diagnostic Codes (cont’d)

CHECK
Sub- TRAN
Main Code code Description Light Inhibited Operation Description
45 (cont’d) 16 General solenoid failure—E Yes DNS
21 General solenoid failure—H/J Yes Turn off trim boost J, DNS H
22 General solenoid failure—A Yes No action taken
23 General solenoid failure—D Yes DNS
24 General solenoid failure—I Yes No action taken
26 General solenoid failure—C Yes DNS
46 21 Hi side overcurrent, H/J solenoid Yes Turn off H/J solenoid, DNS 8610, 9810
(pg 5–46)
26 Hi side overcurrent, C, D, E solenoid Yes Turn off C, D, E solenoids
circuit
27 Hi side overcurrent, A, B, F, G, I, K Yes DNS. Turn off A, B, F, G, I, K solenoids.
solenoid circuit
56 11 Range verification ratio test, 1st Yes DNS
(pg 5–48)
22 Range verification ratio test, 2nd Yes DNS
33 Range verification ratio test, 3rd Yes DNS
44 Range verification ratio test, 4th Yes DNS
55 Range verification ratio test, 5th Yes DNS
66 Range verification ratio test, 6th Yes DNS
77 Range verification ratio test, 7th or R1 Yes DNS
88 Range verification ratio test, 8th or R2 Yes DNS
99 Neutral verification ratio test, N Yes DNS, “cateye” (-/-) display
65 00 Engine rating too high Yes DNS, Lock-in-neutral
(pg 5–50)
66 00 Serial communications interface fault No Use default throttle values
(pg 5–52)
69 27 ECU, inoperative A, B, F, G, I, K Yes DNS, SOL OFF
(pg 5–54) solenoid
28 ECU, inoperative H/J solenoid Yes DNS, SOL OFF
29 ECU, inoperative C, D, E solenoid Yes DNS, SOL OFF
33 ECU, Computer Operating Properly Yes Reset ECU, shutdown ECU on 2nd
(COP) fault occurrence (power loss; hydraulic
defaults). May cause “cateye” (-/-) display
or all segments blank display

5–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


Table 5–2. CEC2 Diagnostic Codes (cont’d)

CHECK
Sub- TRAN
Main Code code Description Light Inhibited Operation Description
69 (cont’d) 34 ECU, EEPROM, fault Yes DNS, SOL OFF
35 ECU, EEPROM, fault Yes Reset ECU
39 Communication chip addressing error Yes Use defaults for J1939 data
42 SPI output failure No GPO 1–8 and reverse warning inoperable
43 SPI input failure Yes DNS, lock-in-range

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–7


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 13 XX—ECU INPUT VOLTAGE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT

VIM

Y
A
R
G
TO
ECU ECU
F1

E1
K
C

UE
LA
B

BL
E2 A1
A2
V CONNECTOR J1
FROM
BL
UE (GRAY) K1 BATTERY

S CONNECTOR V16 K2
(BLACK) V32 J2
V26
V1 C1
V17
S16
S32 HARNESS TERMINALS
S4 VIM TERMINALS
S17 S1
143*–V17 GRAY
V17 A1 L1 K1
BATTERY
RETURN 143*–V32 GRAY
V32 A2 L2 K2

ECU VIM
136*–V1 PINK
V1 E1 R1 J1
BATTERY
POWER 136*–V16 PINK
V16 E2 R2 J2

146–V26 YELLOW
IGNITION V26 F1 S1 C1

PACKARD + –
DEUTSCH (6-PIN) 12 OR 24 VOLT
S32 S16 S4 BATTERY

YELLOW 146*–S4
H C DIAGNOSTIC
PINK
TOOL
GRAY 143*–S32 CONNECTOR
A E

136*–S16 PRIMARY H
R
PINK SHIFT A
143*–S32 SELECTOR DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
P
GRAY CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
(PACKARD)
R E
P
C
PSS ALT DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
CONNECTOR 6-PIN CONNECTOR
See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location (DEUTSCH)
*Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates a splice to the same number wire.
See wiring schematic in Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.
V06595.00.01

Figure 5–1. Code 13 Schematic Drawing

5–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 13 XX—ECU INPUT VOLTAGE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–1)

Main code 13 indicates either a high or low input voltage. Low voltage is less than 8 volts. High voltage is over
33 volts.

Common causes for a low voltage code are:


• Bad batteries
• Faulty vehicle charging system
• No dedicated power and ground connection directly to the battery or through an electronic bus bar to
the battery
Common causes for the high voltage code are:
• Faulty vehicle alternator
• Faulty vehicle voltage regulator

Main Code Subcode Meaning


13 12 Battery voltage to the ECU too low
13 23 Battery voltage to the ECU too high

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

B. Troubleshooting:
1. Connect a diagnostic tool and turn on vehicle ignition. Select Diagnostic Data to find input volt-
age. Record reading.
2. Turn off vehicle ignition and remove the connectors from the ECU.
3. Test the system voltage at wire 136A and 136C, pin V1 and V16. If power is low or high at this
point, and the diagnostic tool reading is also low or high, the vehicle wiring is suspect. Test for
fuse problems, lack of battery-direct power and ground, faulty charging system/batteries, and
loose or dirty connections (refer to Appendix A). Power may also be low or high at pins V1 and
V16 (system power) if the batteries/charging system is faulty. Bad grounds may also cause
incorrect input power readings.
4. If power is correct but the diagnostic tool reading indicates incorrect voltage, closely inspect
terminals V1 and V16 or S16; make sure they are not corroded or deformed. Clean or replace
as necessary (refer to Appendix C, Paragraph C–1).
5. If the voltage condition is intermittent, closely inspect the vehicle wiring for transmission system
power and grounds. Inspect for loose, dirty, or painted connections. Inspect the VIM for loose,
incorrect, or overheating relays or fuses (refer to APPENDIX E—WELDING ON VEHICLE/
VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE). Inspect for wires that are chafed and touching other
components.
6. If no other cause is found, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall
the original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works,

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–9


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 13 XX—ECU INPUT VOLTAGE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–1)

inspect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent condi-
tion. If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.

Table 5–3. Voltage Chart

Voltage Condition
33.0 High Fail Limit, Set Code, DNS
(High Set Point)
32.0 Maximum Continuous ECU Voltage
8.0 Low Voltage Fail Limit, Set Code, DNS
(Low Set Point)
7.0 Software Off (ECU loses power)
4.5 Neutral Start Off

5–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–11


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 21 XX—THROTTLECODES
TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC FAULT PRESENT

T CONNECTOR
(BLUE)

Y
A
T9

R
G
ECU T10

T25 T1

K
C
UE

LA
B
BL

V CONNECTOR
(GRAY)
UE
BL
V10

V8
V24

TEMPERATURE C
SENSOR

A
B
TPS C
CONNECTOR
124*–T9 PINK
THROTTLE C T9 SENSOR POWER (+5V)
POSITION
SENSOR 156–T10 BLUE
B T10 THROTTLE SIGNAL
(TPS)
9,000 – 15,000 Ω 135* –T25 GREEN
A T25 GROUND

SEE NOTE
ECU
THROTTLE 124*–V8 PINK
C V8 SENSOR POWER (+5V)
POSITION
SENSOR 156–V10 BLUE
B V10 THROTTLE SIGNAL
(TPS)
(Optional) A
135*–V24 GREEN
V24 GROUND
9,000 – 15,000 Ω

SEE NOTE

*Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates a splice to the same number wire.
See wiring schematic in Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.
NOTE: These wires may pass through a bulkhead connector. See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location. V06596

Figure 5–2. Code 21 Schematic Drawing

5–12 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 21 XX—THROTTLE FAULT


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC (FigurePRESENT
CODES 5–2)

The throttle position sensor (TPS) must have been recognized by autodetect or manually selected using Allison
DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool (refer to the manual supplied with the diagnostic
tool being used) before these codes can be logged. See Paragraph 1–9 for further information.

Main code 21 indicates the throttle position sensor has been retracted or extended by its linkage into an error zone.
This may be due to a fault with the sensor, or a fault in the wiring to the sensor or to the ECU. Code 21 12 is set
when the ECU receives TPS counts of 14 or less. Code 21 23 is set when the ECU senses TPS counts of 233–255.
Whenever a code 21 XX condition is detected, the system uses default throttle values.

NOTE: Code 21 XX in conjunction with code 33 XX indicates the potential loss of common ground wire 135
between the throttle and temperature sensor.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


21 12 Throttle position sensor failed low
21 23 Throttle position sensor failed high

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1. Also, measure the ECU input voltage.

B. Troubleshooting:

1. Plug in a diagnostic tool, select Diagnostic Data, and read throttle counts and percent. If the TPS
failed high (code 21 23), the problem may be toward the full throttle end of the TPS travel. If the
TPS failed low (code 21 12), the problem may be at the closed throttle end of the TPS travel.

NOTE: Code 21 12 may occur when the throttle source is J1587 or J1939 and an analog throttle source is
falsely detected. This condition may be due to a problem in an unused TPS branch of a universal
external harness. To prevent this occurrence, remove wire 156 from the ECU connector and insert a
cavity plug in the space vacated by the wire. Be sure that the unused TPS branch is routed away from
potential induced voltage sources and the connector is protected from external contamination.

NOTE: Code 21 12 can result when the +5V line (wire 124) which powers the analog sensor is shorted to
ground. Wire 124 also powers the shift selector and is present in all three ECU connectors.

2. If counts are high but the percentage never reaches 100 percent, TPS linkage may have bound up
and overstroked the TPS to set a false 100 percent reading. After TPS overstroking ceases, the
TPS will not automatically return to 100 percent. After the TPS is correctly installed and adjusted,
use Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool to reset throttle cali-
bration or cycle the ignition 5 times to reset the 0 percent and 100 percent settings. Refer to the
TPS section of this book (Appendix D) for installation and adjustment procedures.

3. If the throttle counts do not change or are erratic, test the throttle sensor wiring for opens, shorts
between wires, or shorts-to-ground. Also test for correct TPS voltages using test wiring harness
J 41339. If wiring problems are found, isolate and repair the fault (refer to Appendix C for repair
information).

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–13


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 21 XX—THROTTLE FAULT


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC (FigurePRESENT
CODES 5–2)

4. If the wiring is satisfactory, replace the throttle position sensor and adjust its linkage so the counts
are not in the error zones (refer to Appendix D).

5. If the TPS and its linkage adjustment are correct and the wiring to the sensor is satisfactory, the
condition is intermittent. Replace the sensor and properly adjust the new sensor.

6. If the condition recurs, use a spare wire, if available, or provide a new wire (St. Clair P/N 200153 may
be used for this purpose) for the TPS circuit. Refer to Appendix C for connector repair information.

7. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the
original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works, in-
spect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent condition.
If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.

NOTE: A good throttle position sensor should have resistance of:


(1) 9000–15,000 Ohms across terminals A and C.
(2) 500 Ohms, moving to 9000–15,000 Ohms as TPS is moved from the fully retracted to the
fully extended position, measured across terminals A and B (refer to Figure 1–6).

5–14 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–15


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 22 XX—SPEED SENSOR/CIRCUITRY


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC FAULT
CODES PRESENT

Y
A
R
G
ECU

K
C
UE

LA
T CONNECTOR

B
BL

(BLUE)
T14
T15
UE
BL

T16
T32
T31
T30

SEE NOTE 1

INPUT 141–T14 TAN


A T14 ENGINE SPEED HI
SPEED 150–T30 ORANGE
SENSOR B T30 ENGINE SPEED LO

A
B ECU

TURBINE 149–T15 ORANGE


A T15 TURBINE SPEED HI
SPEED 140–T31 BLUE
SENSOR B T31 TURBINE SPEED LO

A
B

OUTPUT 139–T16 YELLOW


A T16 OUTPUT SPEED HI
SPEED 148–T32 GREEN
SENSOR B T32 OUTPUT SPEED LO

SEE NOTE 1
A
B
SPEED SENSOR CIRCUITS
Use twisted pairs of wires

See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location.


NOTE 1: These wires may pass through a bulkhead connector.
V06597.00.01

Figure 5–3. Code 22 Schematic Drawing

5–16 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 22 XX—SPEED SENSOR/CIRCUITRY


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC FAULT
CODES (Figure 5–3)
PRESENT
Main code 22 indicates a fault within a speed sensor, the wiring to a speed sensor, incorrect speed sensor gap, or
damaged bumps or teeth which create the speed signal. This fault is determined by the reasonableness of a speed
sensor signal when compared with the other two speed sensors and the commanded range. A speed sensor will not
pass the reasonableness test if there is no signal at all from that sensor when a signal should be present.

NOTE: If the input (engine) speed sensor code (22 14) is active and a range verification test is failed, the range
verification code will not be set but a DO NOT SHIFT response is commanded.

Main Code Subcode Failed Sensor


22 14 Input (Engine) Speed
22 15 Turbine Speed
22 16 Output Speed

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1. Also, measure the ECU input voltage.

B. Troubleshooting:
1. Determine if the sensor is loose, missing, or disconnected. If not, disconnect the wiring harness
from the sensor and measure the resistance of the sensor (see chart below). Also inspect the termi-
nals for dirt, corrosion, or damage. If resistance is not correct, replace the sensor.

Current Resistance (Ohms) Former Resistance (Ohms)


Temp ˚F Temp ˚C
January, 2006 Before January, 2006
250 200 –40 –40
340 300 68 20
450 400 230 110

2. Remove the transmission harness connector from the ECU. Test the sensor circuit (in the external
harness) for open wires, shorts between wires, or shorts-to-ground. Isolate and repair any faults
(refer to Appendix C for repair information).
3. If no opens or shorts are found, the condition must be intermittent. Replace the sensor indicated
by the trouble code. Before replacing a speed sensor, inspect the sensor for physical damage or
contamination. Refer to the appropriate transmission service manual for proper replacement
procedure.
4. If the condition recurs, install new wiring (twisted-pair) for the sensor circuit between the ECU
and the transmission. Use St. Clair P/N 200153 Service Harness Twisted Pair for this purpose.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–17


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 22 XX—SPEED SENSOR/CIRCUITRY


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC FAULT
CODES (Figure 5–3)
PRESENT
5. If the condition again recurs, connect the diagnostic tool and select the speed signal indicated by
the trouble code. Drive the vehicle and watch the speed reading on the diagnostic tool. If the signal
is erratic, the following may be inducing the erratic signal:
• Sensor gap
• Vehicle vibration
• External AC signal source
• Intermittent connector contact.
Inspect the sensor and its surroundings for irregularities that would affect sensor gap. Isolate and
correct any abnormal vehicle vibrations, particularly driveline and abnormal engine torsionals.
Refer to the Off-Highway Tech Data on the Allison Transmission extranet through an Allison
distributor, dealer, or OEM. Also refer to the Applications Manual, Section C. Re-test the sensor
wiring for intermittent conditions (refer to Appendix A).
6. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the
original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works,
inspect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent
condition. If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.

5–18 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–19


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 23 XX—SHIFT SELECTOR


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT

GR
AY VIM

ECU

K
AC
BL UE
BL S CONNECTOR
(BLACK)
E1
BL
UE S16 A1
S32

S17 S1

143–V17 GRAY
A1 L1
136–V1 PINK
E1 R1 VIM
V17 V1

136*–S16
BATTERY POWER S16 R

143*–S32
BATTERY RETURN S32 P

124*–S3 PINK
SENSOR POWER S3 N COMMON TO
PSS AND SSS
175*–S10 GREEN
MODE INPUT S10 M

180*–S14 BLUE PRIMARY


DISPLAY S14 S SHIFT
176–S15 ORANGE
SELECTOR (PSS)
GPO 31/GPO 6 S15 L CONNECTOR
AND
173 –S8 YELLOW
PSS 8 S8 D SECONDARY
ECU SHIFT
172–S7 BLUE SELECTOR (SSS)
PSS 4 S7 C
CONNECTOR
PSS 2 S6
171–S6 GREEN
B (OPTIONAL)

170–S5 ORANGE PSS ONLY


PSS 1 S5 A

174 –S9 TAN


PSS P S9 E

194–S25 TAN
SSS P S25 E

193–S24 YELLOW
SSS 8 S24 D
R
192–S23 BLUE P
SSS 4 S23 C SSS ONLY
(IF PRESENT) L A
E
191–S22 GREEN
SSS 2 S22 B
PSS OR SSS
190–S21 ORANGE CONNECTOR
SSS 1 S21 A

See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location


*Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates a splice to the same number wire.
See wiring schematic in Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.
V06598

Figure 5–4. Code 23 Schematic Drawing

5–20 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 23 XX—SHIFT SELECTOR


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC (Figure PRESENT
CODES 5–4)

Main code 23 indicates a fault with a shift selector or the wiring between a shift selector and the ECU.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


23 12 Primary shift selector fault—a “cateye” (-/-) type display may occur
23 13 Primary shift selector mode function fault. Mode change not permitted
23 14 Secondary shift selector fault—a “cateye” (-/-) type display may occur
23 15 Secondary shift selector mode function fault. Mode change not permitted
23 16 Shift selector display line fault

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1.

B. Troubleshooting:
1. Clear the active indicator for code 23 XX. If code recurs, continue to Step (2).
2. Inspect for a poor connection at the shift selector.

NOTE: Code 23 12 can result when the +5V line (wire 124) which powers the shift selector is shorted to
ground. Wire 124 also powers the TPS and is present in all three ECU connectors.

3. Disconnect the selector “S” harness connector from the ECU and from the shift selector and test
for opens, shorts, and shorts-to-ground between the shift selector and ECU (refer to Section 3).
Repair as needed (refer to Appendix C).
4. If no problem is found with the shift selector connection or wiring, replace the shift selector.
5. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the
original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works,
inspect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent
condition. If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–21


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 24 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT

Y
A
R
G
ECU

K
C
UE

LA
B
BL

BL
UE
T CONNECTOR
(BLUE)

C T27
THROTTLE T25

A
POSITION B
TPS B SENSOR
C
CONNECTOR (TPS) A

135*–T25
D D
GREEN
T25 GROUND
TRANSMISSION
100 – 100,000 Ω SUMP LOCKUP
TEMP VALVE BODY SEE NOTE
SENSOR ECU

147–T27 TAN
C C T27 SUMP TEMP (+5V)

INTERNAL
HARNESS

D A
C B

A D
CHASSIS HARNESS
LOCKUP VALVE BODY
B C CONNECTOR
5/6/8/9000 SERIES
OFF-HIGHWAY LOCKUP SOLENOID/TEMP SENSOR
TRANSMISSION HARNESS CONNECTOR

*Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates a splice to the same number wire.
See wiring schematic in Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.

NOTE: These wires may pass through a bulkhead connector. See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location V06599

Figure 5–5. Code 24 Schematic Drawing

5–22 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 24 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–5)

Main code 24 indicates the ECU has detected either a high or low fluid temperature in the transmission (via the
sump temperature sensor in the internal lockup valve body harness). All shifts are inhibited when code 24 12 is set
(only Neutral range operation is allowed). No upshifts are allowed above a calibration range when code 24 23 is
set. All inhibits are cleared when the temperature conditions are normal. A related code is 33 12 which indicates a
temperature reading outside the usable range of the sensor and indicates a probable sensor failure.

Detailed troubleshooting information for the sump thermistor is shown in Appendix L.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


24 12 Sump fluid temperature cold
24 23 Sump fluid temperature hot

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1. Also, measure the ECU input voltage.

B. Troubleshooting:
Code 24 12:

1. If the outside temperature is between –25˚F (–32˚C) and +20˚F (–7˚C), the ECU will allow
reverse, neutral, and limited forward drive operation. Only hold override upshifts are allowed (re-
fer to Table 5–4 on next page.) The sump must be warmed to an acceptable temperature to avoid
logging codes and transmission diagnostic response.

NOTE: Code 24 12 can result when the +5V line (wire 147) which powers the sump temperature sensor is
shorted to ground.

2. After allowing the temperatures to normalize, if ambient temperature does not match the sump
temperature reading (test using a diagnostic tool), compare resistance versus sump fluid tempera-
ture. Refer to Appendix L. If resistance measurement is acceptable, then test the sensor wiring for
opens, shorts, or shorts-to-ground.
3. If the sensor wiring is satisfactory, remove the lockup body cover and replace the temperature
sensor which is in the internal lockup harness (refer to appropriate transmission service manual).
4. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall
the original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now
works, inspect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage that may cause an intermittent
condition. If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–23


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 24 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
Table 5–4. Transmission Operation as a Function of Temperature

Condition ˚F ˚C
Temperature sensor failed high (refer to code 33 23) 350* 177
Hot fluid (code 24 23) maximum range limited 250* 121
Medium cold fluid R, N, D allowed (hold override upshifts only) 20* –7
Temperature sensor failed low (refer to code 33 12) –55* –48

Code 24 23:
1. Install temperature gauges for transmission temperature and engine water temperature. Drive the
vehicle. Verify that the code can be reproduced and verify the reading shown on the diagnostic
tool. Observe the gauges and test for hot fluid when the code is produced.
2. If the fluid is not hot when the code is produced, remove the transmission “T” harness connector
at the ECU and the transmission. Test the fluid temperature sensor wiring for opens, shorts, and
shorts-to-ground. Compare the resistance readings of the sensor and the actual temperature
shown on the gauge with the chart information in Figure 5–6. If wiring problems or a great
difference between temperature and resistance compared with the chart are found, remove the
lockup valve body cover and replace the temperature sensor which is part of the internal lockup
harness (refer to the appropriate transmission service manual). If wiring problems are found,
repair or replace as necessary.

3. If the fluid is hot when the code is produced, observe the gauges to see if the engine became hot
before the transmission. If the engine cooling system is overheating and heating the transmission,
the problem is with the engine or its cooling system.

4. If the transmission became hot before the engine, allow the vehicle to idle for 3–5 minutes and
determine the transmission fluid level. Correct the fluid level if necessary.

5. If no problems are found in the transmission, remove the transmission and disassemble, inspecting
for causes of overheating (stuck stator, plugged orifices, dragging clutches, etc.). Refer to the ap-
propriate transmission service manual.

C. Resistance Vs. Temperature Characteristics


Figure 5–6 is a graph of the temperature indicated by the resistance measured in the thermistor. The
thermistor has a negative temperature coefficient which means the indicated temperature increases as
the measured resistance decreases within a range of about 200,000 Ohms down to about 50 Ohms.

* This is a programmed value subject to change.

5–24 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 24 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT

RESISTANCE-TEMPERATURE
CHARACTERISTIC CHART
1,000,000

100,000
SENSOR RESISTANCE ( )

10,000

1,000

100

10

1
— 40 14 68 122 176 230 284 338 392 ¡F

—40 —10 20 50 80 110 140 170 200 ¡C


TEMPERATURE
CEC 2 Negative Temperature Coefficient Sensor Sump
V06664

Figure 5–6. Temperature Sensor Chart

NOTE: Look carefully at the graph. The scale for the resistance (on the left side) is not constant (linear). It is
logarithmic which means it can display a great range of values within a small space. Each section of
the graph is ten units, but the units vary from 1 to 100,000 Ohms.

The following table shows the range of resistance values that correspond to the sump fluid temperature shown in
one degree increments over the operating range of the thermistors.

Table 5–5. Sump Thermistor—Resistance (Ohms) vs. Temperature


Sump Thermistor Sump Thermistor
Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi
C F Ohms Ohms Ohms C F Ohms Ohms Ohms
–50 –58 202642 182288 226183 –11 12.2 17043 16424 17900
–49 –56.2 188561 169859 210206 –10 14 16120 15540 16924
–48 –54.4 175549 158357 195459 –9 15.8 15251 14709 16006
–47 –52.6 163519 147708 181840 –8 17.6 14434 13927 15143
–46 –50.8 152390 137844 169255 –7 19.4 13666 13190 14331
–45 –49 142089 128702 157621 –6 21.2 12942 12497 13567
–44 –47.2 132550 120224 146860 –5 23 12261 11844 12848
–43 –45.4 123711 112359 136900 –4 24.8 11619 11228 12171
–42 –43.6 115517 105057 127678 –3 26.6 11014 10648 11533

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–25


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 24 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
Table 5–5. Sump Thermistor—Resistance (Ohms) vs. Temperature (cont’d)
Sump Thermistor Sump Thermistor
Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi
C F Ohms Ohms Ohms C F Ohms Ohms Ohms
–41 –41.8 107917 98276 119134 –2 28.4 10444 10101 10932
–40 –40 100865 95956 107181 –1 30.2 9906 9585 10365
–39 –38.2 94317 89769 100181 0 32 9399 9098 9831
–38 –36.4 88235 84019 93681 1 33.8 8921 8638 9329
–37 –34.6 82582 78674 87642 2 35.6 8470 8203 8854
–36 –32.8 77326 73701 82030 3 37.4 8044 7793 8407
–35 –31 72437 69073 76811 4 39.2 7643 7406 7985
–34 –29.2 67886 64764 71956 5 41 7263 7041 7587
–33 –27.4 63649 60749 67497 6 42.8 6905 6696 7211
–32 –25.6 59702 57008 63228 7 44.6 6567 6369 6855
–31 –23.8 56024 53520 59308 8 46.4 6247 6061 6519
–30 –22 52594 50266 55654 9 48.2 5944 5769 6202
–29 –20.2 49394 47229 52247 10 50 5658 5493 5902
–28 –18.4 46408 44394 49069 11 51.8 5387 5231 5618
–27 –16.6 43620 41746 46102 12 53.6 5131 4984 5349
–26 –14.8 41016 39271 43332 13 55.4 4888 4750 5095
–25 –13 38583 36958 40745 14 57.2 4659 4528 4854
–24 –11.2 36308 34794 38328 15 59 4441 4318 4626
–23 –9.4 34181 32770 36088 16 60.8 4235 4118 4410
–22 –7.6 32190 30875 33954 17 62.6 4039 3929 4205
–21 –5.8 30327 29101 31976 18 64.4 3854 3750 4011
–20 –4 28582 27439 30125 19 66.2 3678 3580 3827
–19 –2.2 26948 25881 28391 20 68 3511 3418 3653
–18 –0.4 25417 24420 26767 21 69.8 3353 3265 3487
–17 1.4 23981 23051 25245 22 71.6 3202 3120 3330
–16 3.2 22634 21766 23818 23 73.4 3060 2981 3180
–15 5 21371 20660 22480 24 75.2 2924 2850 3039
–14 6.8 20185 19427 21225 25 77 2795 2725 2904
–13 8.6 19072 18363 20046 26 78.8 2673 2606 2776
–12 10.4 18026 17363 18940 27 80.6 2556 2493 2655
28 82.4 2445 2385 2540 67 152.6 520.9 509.8 540.9
29 84.2 2340 2282 2430 68 154.4 502.8 492.1 522.2
30 86 2240 2185 2326 69 156.2 485.4 475.2 504.1
31 87.8 2144 2092 2227 70 158 468.7 458.9 486.8
32 89.6 2053 2003 2132 71 159.8 452.7 443.2 470.2
33 91.4 1967 1919 2043 72 161.6 437.3 428.2 454.2
34 93.2 1884 1839 1957 73 163.4 422.5 413.7 438.9
35 95 1806 1763 1875 74 165.2 408.3 399.8 424.1
36 96.8 1731 1690 1797 75 167 394.6 386.5 410

5–26 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 24 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
Table 5–5. Sump Thermistor—Resistance (Ohms) vs. Temperature (cont’d)
Sump Thermistor Sump Thermistor
Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi
C F Ohms Ohms Ohms C F Ohms Ohms Ohms
37 98.6 1660 1620 1723 76 168.8 381.5 373.6 396.3
38 100.4 1592 1554 1653 77 170.6 368.9 361.3 383.2
39 102.2 1527 1491 1585 78 172.4 356.7 349.4 370.6
40 104 1465 1430 1521 79 174.2 345 338 358.5
41 105.8 1406 1373 1459 80 176 333.8 327 346.8
42 107.6 1349 1318 1401 81 177.8 322.9 316.4 335.6
43 109.4 1296 1265 1345 82 179.6 312.5 306.2 324.7
44 111.2 1244 1215 1291 83 181.4 302.5 296.4 314.3
45 113 1195 1167 1240 84 183.2 292.8 288.9 304.3
46 114.8 1148 1122 1192 85 185 283.5 277.8 294.6
47 116.6 1103 1078 1145 86 186.8 274.5 269 285.4
48 118.4 1060 1036 1100 87 188.6 265.9 260.5 276.5
49 120.2 1019 996.3 1058 88 190.4 257.6 253.3 268
50 122 980.3 958.1 1017 89 192.2 249.5 244.3 259.7
51 123.8 942.9 921.6 978.4 90 194 241.8 236.7 251.7
52 125.6 907.1 886.7 941.4 91 195.8 234.4 229.4 244
53 127.4 872.9 853.3 905.9 92 197.6 227.2 222.3 236.6
54 129.2 840.1 821.4 871.9 93 199.4 220.2 215.5 229.5
55 131 808.8 790.8 839.4 94 201.2 213.5 208.9 222.6
56 132.8 778.8 761.5 808.3 95 203 207.1 202.5 215.9
57 134.6 750 733.5 778.5 96 204.8 200.9 196.4 209.5
58 136.4 722.5 706.6 750 97 206.6 194.8 190.5 203.3
59 138.2 696.2 680.9 722.7 98 208.4 189 184.8 197.3
60 140 670.9 656.2 696.5 99 210.2 183.4 179.2 191.5
61 141.8 646.7 632.6 671.4 100 212 178 173.9 185.9
62 143.6 623.5 609.9 647.3 101 213.8 172.8 168.8 180.5
63 145.4 601.2 588.2 624.2 102 215.6 167.8 163.8 175.3
64 147.2 579.9 567.4 602.1 103 217.4 162.9 159 170.3
65 149 559.4 547.4 580.8 104 219.2 158.2 154.4 165.4
66 150.8 539.8 528.2 560.5 105 221 159.6 149.9 160.7
106 222.8 149.2 145.6 156.2 129 264.2 79.56 77.35 83.77
107 224.6 145 141.4 151.8 130 266 77.54 75.37 81.65
108 226.4 140.9 137.4 147.5 131 267.8 75.58 73.46 79.6
109 228.2 136.9 133.5 143.4 132 269.6 73.67 71.6 77.61
110 230 133.1 129.7 139.4 133 271.4 71.82 69.8 75.68
111 231.8 129.4 126.1 135.6 134 273.2 70.03 68.05 73.8
112 233.6 125.8 122.6 131.9 135 275 68.29 66.35 71.98
113 235.4 122.3 119.2 128.2 136 276.8 66.6 64.7 70.21
114 237.2 118.9 115.9 124.8 137 278.6 64.96 63.11 68.5

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–27


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 24 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
Table 5–5. Sump Thermistor—Resistance (Ohms) vs. Temperature (cont’d)
Sump Thermistor Sump Thermistor
Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi Degree Degree Lo Nominal Hi
C F Ohms Ohms Ohms C F Ohms Ohms Ohms
115 239 115.7 112.7 121.4 138 280.4 63.37 61.56 66.83
116 240.8 112.5 109.6 118.1 139 282.2 61.82 60.05 65.21
117 242.6 109.5 106.6 114.9 140 284 60.32 58.59 63.64
118 244.4 106.5 103.7 111.9 141 285.8 58.86 57.17 62.11
119 246.2 103.7 100.91 108.9 142 287.6 57.45 55.79 60.63
120 248 100.9 98.2 106 143 289.4 56.07 54.45 59.18
121 249.8 98.23 95.58 103.2 144 291.2 54.73 53.15 57.78
122 251.6 95.63 93.04 100.5 145 293 53.43 51.89 56.42
123 253.4 93.12 90.58 97.9 146 294.8 52.17 50.66 55.09
124 255.2 90.68 88.2 95.36 147 296.6 50.94 49.47 53.81
125 257 88.32 85.89 92.9 148 298.4 49.75 48.31 52.55
126 258.8 86.03 83.65 90.51 149 300.2 48.59 47.18 51.34
127 260.6 83.8 81.49 88.19 150 302 47.46 46.09 50.15
128 262.4 81.65 79.38 85.95 — — — — —

5–28 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–29


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 25TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC
XX—OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR, DETECTED AT ZERO SPEED,
CODES PRESENT
X RANGE

AY
GR

ECU

K
AC
BL UE
BL T CONNECTOR
(BLUE)
T14
T15
UE
BL

T16
T32
T31
T30

SEE NOTE 1

INPUT 141–T14 TAN


A T14 ENGINE SPEED HI
SPEED 150–T30 ORANGE
SENSOR B T30 ENGINE SPEED LO

A
B ECU

TURBINE 149–T15 ORANGE


A T15 TURBINE SPEED HI
SPEED 140–T31 BLUE
SENSOR B T31 TURBINE SPEED LO

A
B

OUTPUT 139–T16 YELLOW


A T16 OUTPUT SPEED HI
SPEED 148–T32 GREEN
SENSOR B T32 OUTPUT SPEED LO

SEE NOTE 1
A
B
SPEED SENSOR CIRCUITS
Use twisted pairs of wires

See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location.


NOTE 1: These wires may pass through a bulkhead connector.
V06597.00.01

Figure 5–7. Code 25 Schematic Drawing

5–30 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
CODE 25TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC
XX—OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR, DETECTED AT ZERO SPEED,
CODES PRESENT
X RANGE (Figure 5–7)
Main code 25 occurs if the output speed sensor reports a zero speed reading while both engine and turbine speeds
are approximately equal, turbine speed is above a calibration value, and neutral is not selected or commanded.
Main code 25 indicates either the output speed sensor has failed or the required oncoming clutch or clutches did not
come on. Code 25 11 can be generated by a false turbine speed reading. This may be due to crosstalk between
solenoid and turbine speed sensor circuits caused by direct wire-to-wire short or by water in the electrical
connectors. See Section 4 for corrective action.

NOTE: If code 25 XX is in memory at ECU initialization (ignition on), all display segments are illuminated.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


25 11 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 1st range
25 22 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 2nd range
25 33 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 3rd range
25 44 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 4th range
25 55 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 5th range
25 66 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 6th range
25 77 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 7th range
25 88 Output speed sensor, detected at zero speed, 8th range

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1. Also, measure battery and ECU input voltages.

NOTE: Intermittent connections or lack of battery-direct power and ground connections can cause this and
other codes.

B. Troubleshooting:
1. Determine transmission fluid level to be sure it is correct.
2. Determine if code 22 16 is present. If code 22 16 is in the code list, go to code 22 XX section and
follow troubleshooting steps for code 22 16.
3. Connect the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool with ignition
on, engine off, and determine if there are turbine speed indications. If turbine speed is indicated,
refer to Paragraph 4–2 for corrective action.
4. This code requires accurate output and turbine speed readings. If there were no transmission prob-
lems detected, use the diagnostic tool and watch the speed readings for noise (erratic signals) from
low speed to high speed in the range indicated by the code.
5. If a noisy sensor is found, measure the sensor resistance (refer to the following sensor resistance
chart) and test its wiring for opens, shorts, and shorts-to-ground (refer to code 22 XX). Also
closely inspect the terminals in the connectors for corrosion, contamination, or damage. Be sure
the wiring to the sensors is a properly twisted wire pair. Remove sensor and inspect for damage at
the tone wheel end. Inspect for looseness of the tone wheel. Refer to the appropriate service
manual if repair of a loose tone wheel is necessary. Replace the sensor if it is damaged or if its

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–31


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
CODE 25TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC
XX—OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR, DETECTED AT ZERO SPEED,
CODES PRESENT
X RANGE (Figure 5–7)
resistance is incorrect (refer to appropriate service manual for proper procedure) and isolate and
repair any noted wiring problems. (Use St. Clair P/N 200153 Service Harness Twisted Pair for this
procedure.)

Current Resistance (Ohms) Former Resistance (Ohms)


Temp ˚F Temp ˚C
January, 2006 Before January, 2006
250 200 –40 –40
340 300 68 20
450 400 230 110

6. If no apparent cause for the code can be located, replace the turbine and output speed sensors.
Refer to the appropriate transmission service manual for proper procedure.
7. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the
original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works,
inspect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent
condition. If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.
8. If the output speed sensor and wiring are satisfactory, install pressure gauges into the appropriate
clutch pressure taps (refer to appropriate transmission service manual) and make the shift again.
See if the clutches have low or no pressure.
9. If a clutch is leaking pressure, remove the valve body and check for damaged valve body gaskets
and stuck or sticky valves. If no problems are found, replace the solenoids for the clutches used in
the range indicated by the code. Refer to the appropriate transmission service manual for replace-
ment procedure.
10. If, after detecting leaking pressure and replacing solenoids, the problem persists, inspect clutch or
piston seals for wear. Remove the transmission and repair or replace as necessary (refer to the
proper transmission service manual).

5–32 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 26 XX—THROTTLE SOURCE CODES


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC NOT DETECTED
PRESENT
Main code 26 occurs when the ECU has not detected a throttle source. This is a new code related to the autodetect
feature which is described in Paragraph 1–9.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


26 00 Throttle source not detected

Code 26 00 means that the ECU has not detected the presence of engine throttle data or analog circuitry. For details
about autodetect, refer to Paragraph 1–9. For information about the use of Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool,
refer to Allison Transmission publication GN3433EN, User Guide or Appendix J. For information about the use of
Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool, refer to the User’s Manual, GN2928EN, or Appendix J.

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure


• Power down
• Manual

B. Troubleshooting
When code 26 00 is logged and an analog TPS is known to be installed, refer to code 21 XX for
troubleshooting steps. If a J1587 or J1939 throttle signal is used, refer to code 66 00 for
troubleshooting steps.

C. Autodetect Feature
Autodetect is active on the first 10* engine starts. Autodetect takes place within the first 5–25* seconds
of each engine start monitored. For CEC2, autodetect searches for the presence of a throttle
information source. Autodetect searches for a TPS (analog) source or a data link source via J1939 or
J1587.

Even after autodetect has been completed, it can be reset to monitor an additional group of engine
starts. Reset may be necessary if a device known to be present is not detected or if an autodetectable
component or sensor was added after the initial vehicle build. Reset is accomplished by using the
Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool. If using the CEC2
compatible Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool, select “RESET AUTODETECT.” The Allison DOC™
For PC–Service Tool or CEC2 Pro-Link® diagnostic tool can also be used to override autodetect and
manually enter the component or sensor to be recognized by the ECU by changing appropriate
“customer modifiable constants”. The throttle source is the only customer modifiable constant
(CMC) that is autodetected. Other CMCs can be changed at any time and are not related to
autodetect. Consult the Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool manual for detailed instructions related to
CEC2 “customer modifiable constants.” Additional details for the autodetectable throttle feature is
given below.

Whenever autodetect is functioning and no throttle source is found, a code 26 00 is logged. If a


datalink throttle source (J1939 or J1587) is detected, autodetect stops looking for that function.
However, if no analog throttle source was detected prior to engine start 10*, autodetect continues for
engine starts 10* through a calibration number. Autodetect for analog throttle stops as soon as a
device is detected or when the calibration number of starts is reached. If an analog throttle source is
known to be present, but is not detected, troubleshooting of the analog throttle circuit is required.
After the analog throttle circuit is repaired, reset autodetect or manually select the analog throttle
function using Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® diagnostic tool. An engine throttle
source must be present.

* This is a programmed value subject to change.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–33


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 33 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC SENSOR
CODES PRESENT

Y
A
R
G
ECU

K
C
UE

LA
B
BL

BL
UE
“T” CONNECTOR
(BLUE)

C T27
THROTTLE T25

A
POSITION B
TPS B SENSOR
C
CONNECTOR (TPS) A

135*–T25
C C
GREEN
T25 GROUND
TRANSMISSION
100 – 100,000 Ω SUMP LOCKUP
TEMP VALVE BODY SEE NOTE
SENSOR ECU

147–T27 TAN
D D T27 SUMP TEMP (+5V)

INTERNAL
HARNESS

D A
C B

A D
CHASSIS HARNESS
LOCKUP VALVE BODY
B C CONNECTOR
5/6/8/9000 SERIES
OFF-HIGHWAY LOCKUP SOLENOID/TEMP SENSOR
TRANSMISSION HARNESS CONNECTOR

*Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates a splice to the same number wire.
See wiring schematic in Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.

NOTE: These wires may pass through a bulkhead connector. See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location V06599.01.00

Figure 5–8. Code 33 Schematic Drawing

5–34 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 33 XX—SUMP FLUID TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC SENSOR
CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–8)

Detailed troubleshooting information for the sump temperature thermistor is shown in Figure 5–9.

Main code 33 indicates the sump temperature sensor is providing a signal outside the usable range of the ECU.
This code indicates the sensor failed showing abnormally high or low temperature readings. Main code 33 can be
caused by a component or circuit failure or by extremely high or low temperatures. There are no operational
inhibits related to main code 33. The ECU assumes a hardware failure and that transmission temperatures are
normal (200ºF; 93ºC). Temperatures above or below normal may cause inhibited range operation.

NOTE: Code 33 23 in conjunction with code 21 23 indicates the loss of common ground (wire 135) between
the throttle and temperature sensors.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


33 12 Sump oil temperature sensor failed low (–55ºF; –48ºC)
33 23 Sump oil temperature sensor failed high (350ºF; 177ºC)

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1. Also, determine the transmission fluid level.

B. Troubleshooting:

NOTE: Code 33 12 can be caused when the +5V power line (wire 147) is shorted to ground or open.

1. If possible, measure the sump temperature using the fastest sample rate available on the Allison
DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool. This is necessary to catch mo-
mentary changes due to an intermittent open or short to ground. If Allison DOC™ For PC–Service
Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool is not available, use the shift selector display to determine
if the code is active (refer to Paragraph 5–2). Disconnect the transmission “T” harness at the ECU
and check resistance of the sensor and compare with Figure 5–9.
2. If Step (1) reveals that the extreme temperature indication is no longer present, the temperature
limit could have been reached due to operational or ambient temperature extremes. Also, you may
be experiencing an intermittent problem and the code will not be active. Proceed cautiously, it is
unlikely there is a sensor hardware fault.
3. Disconnect the external harness at the transmission. Inspect the connectors and terminals for dirt,
corrosion, or damage. Clean or replace as necessary.
4. Test the sensor wires in the external harness for opens (code 33 23), shorts between wires, or
shorts-to-ground (code 33 12—refer to Section 4). If wiring problems are found, isolate and repair
as described in Appendix C, in this manual.
5. Inspect for chafing of the sensor wires. Eliminate the chafe point. If no chafe point is found,
replace the sensor (refer to Paragraph 1–3 or Appendix C in this manual or the appropriate service
manual for the transmission being serviced).

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–35


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 33 XX—SUMP OIL TEMPERATURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC SENSOR
CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–8)

RESISTANCE-TEMPERATURE
CHARACTERISTIC CHART
1,000,000

100,000
SENSOR RESISTANCE ( )

10,000

1,000

100

10

1
— 40 14 68 122 176 230 284 338 392 ¡F

—40 —10 20 50 80 110 140 170 200 ¡C


TEMPERATURE
CEC 2 Negative Temperature Coefficient Sensor Sump
V06664

Figure 5–9. Temperature Sensor Chart

6. If the problem recurs, use a spare wire, if available, or provide a new wire (St. Clair P/N 200153
may be used for this purpose) for the temperature sensor circuit.
7. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the
original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works,
inspect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent
condition. If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.

5–36 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 34 XX—CALIBRATION COMPATIBILITY


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC OR CHECKSUM
CODES PRESENT FAULT
Main code 34 indicates there is a problem with the calibration.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


34 12 Factory calibration compatibility number wrong
34 13 Factory calibration checksum
34 14 Power off block checksum
34 15 Diagnostic queue block checksum
34 16 Real-time block checksum
34 17 Customer modifiable constants checksum

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down

NOTE: Copying the current calibration from the ECU and reloading it will not correct the fault. The
calibration must be downloaded directly from PCCS.

B. Troubleshooting:
1. If the code set is 34 14 and it occurs in conjunction with code 35 00 (Power Interruption), proceed
to find the cause for code 35 00 and correct it.
2. After the cause for code 35 00 has been corrected, drive the vehicle to see if code 34 14 recurs. If
code 34 14 recurs, proceed to Step (3).
3. Reprogram the correct calibration. Contact Allison Transmission to do recalibration. Be certain the
calibration and the software level are compatible.
4. If the code recurs after reprogramming, replace the ECU.
5. If the code set is 34 17, reprogram the GPI/GPO package after re-calibration of the ECU.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–37


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 35 XX—POWER INTERRUPTION


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT

VIM

Y
A
R
G
TO
ECU ECU
F1

E1
K
C

UE
LA
B

BL
E2 A1
A2
V CONNECTOR J1
FROM
BL
UE (GRAY) K1 BATTERY

S CONNECTOR V16 K2
(BLACK) V32 J2
V26
V1 C1
V17
S16
S32 HARNESS TERMINALS
S4 VIM TERMINALS
S17 S1
143*–V17 GRAY
V17 A1 L1 K1
BATTERY
RETURN 143*–V32 GRAY
V32 A2 L2 K2

ECU VIM
136*–V1 PINK
V1 E1 R1 J1
BATTERY
POWER 136*–V16 PINK
V16 E2 R2 J2

146–V26 YELLOW
IGNITION V26 F1 S1 C1

PACKARD + –
DEUTSCH (6-PIN) 12 OR 24 VOLT
S32 S16 S4 BATTERY

YELLOW 146*–S4
H C DIAGNOSTIC
PINK
TOOL
GRAY 143*–S32 CONNECTOR
A E

136*–S16 PRIMARY H
R
PINK SHIFT A
143*–S32 SELECTOR DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
P
GRAY CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
(PACKARD)
R E
P
C
PSS ALT DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
CONNECTOR 6-PIN CONNECTOR
See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location (DEUTSCH)
*Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates a splice to the same number wire.
See wiring schematic in Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.
V06595.00.01
.

Figure 5–10. Code 35 Schematic Drawing

5–38 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 35 XX—POWER INTERRUPTION


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–10)

Main code 35 indicates the ECU has detected a complete power loss before the ignition was turned off or before
ECU shutdown is completed. When this happens, the ECU is not able to save the current operating parameters in
memory before turning itself off.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


35 00 Power interruption. (Not an active code; only appears after power is restored.)
During power interruption, CHECK TRANS light is not illuminated and the
transmission will not shift.
35 16 Real-time write interruption. (Power interruption at the same time the ECU is
recording a critical code to the real-time section.)

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual—except code 35 16

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1. Also, measure battery and ECU input voltages.

B. Troubleshooting:
1. If the vehicle has a master switch controlling battery power to the ECU and an ignition switch,
turning the master switch off before turning the ignition switch off can cause this code. Turning the
master switch off before ECU shutdown is completed will also cause this code. No troubleshoot-
ing is necessary.
2. If improper switch sequencing is not the cause, test ECU power and ground for opens, shorts, and
shorts-to-ground. Not using battery-direct power and battery ground connections can cause this
code. A defective charging system, or open battery fuse or fusible link can also cause this code.
The battery fuse or fusible link may be at the battery or in the VIM. Dirty, corroded, or painted
power and ground connections can also cause this code.
3. If all system power and ground connections are satisfactory and the problem persists, replace the
ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the original (bad) ECU to confirm that
the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works, inspect the ECU connectors for any
corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent condition. If the original problem reoccurs,
reinstall the replacement ECU.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–39


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 36 XX—HARDWARE AND SOFTWARE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC NOTPRESENT
CODES COMPATIBLE

Main code 36 indicates the system has detected a mismatch between the ECU hardware and the ECU software.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


36 00 Mismatch between ECU hardware and software

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down

B. Troubleshooting:
Correction for code 36 00 requires the installation of software that is compatible with the ECU
hardware involved. If a different calibration is required, update the ECU hardware to be compatible.

5–40 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–41


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 45 XX—GENERAL SOLENOID


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC FAILURE
CODES PRESENT

T CONNECTOR
AY

ECU
GR
(BLUE)

K
AC
BL
BL
UE T16
T32

A
B T17 T1
UE
C BL
D

F
G

MAIN VALVE BODY ECU


A 102–T1 ORANGE
J
12 – 24Ω F
B 120–T4 WHITE F SOL
F T4
131–T21 BLUE G SOL
H T21
A 130–T17 YELLOW A,B SOL POWER
A T17
12 – 24Ω A 104–T7 WHITE
B A SOL
B T7
103–T5 GREEN B SOL
D T5
A 116*–T19 YELLOW
B E T19 C,D,E SOL POWER
C 101–T24 BLUE
G 12 – 24Ω B C SOL
A B P T24
12 – 24Ω B B 127–T23 WHITE D SOL
A M T23
D
12 – 24Ω A 129–T6 TAN E SOL
K T6
12 – 24Ω
B N
E
12 – 24Ω A
L
102–T1 ORANGE F,G,I SOL POWER
G T1
130–T17 YELLOW
C

SEE NOTE
LOCKUP BODY
A 121–T2 TAN K SOL POWER
A T2
12 – 24Ω K B 128–T20 ORANGE
B T20 K SOL

LOW-RANGE or
TRIM BOOST BODY
A 102–T1 ORANGE
8610, 9810 LOCK IN D
RANGE MODELS ONLY I B 111–T8 GREEN
12 – 24Ω C T8 I SOL

A 107–T3 GREEN H or J SOL POWER


A T3
5610, 6610, 9610 MODELS
J B 110–T22 WHITE
10–13Ω 12–24Ω B T22 H or J SOL

A
J SOLENOID A NOTE: These wires may pass through a bulkhead connector.
8610 MODEL
CONNECTOR 12 – 24Ω H B
B *Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates
See Appendix B For a splice to the same number wire. See wiring schematic in
Detailed Terminal Location. Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.

L06600

Figure 5–11. Code 45 Schematic Drawing

5–42 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 45 XX—GENERAL SOLENOID FAILURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–11)

Main code 45 indicates the ECU has detected either an open circuit condition in a solenoid coil or the wiring to that
solenoid. The DO NOT SHIFT response is activated when some subcodes are detected and the CHECK TRANS
light is illuminated.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


45 12 General Failure, F Solenoid Circuit
45 13 General Failure, K Solenoid Circuit
45 14 General Failure, B Solenoid Circuit
45 15 General Failure, G Solenoid Circuit
45 16 General Failure, E Solenoid Circuit
45 21 General Failure, H/J Solenoid Circuit
45 22 General Failure, A Solenoid Circuit
45 23 General Failure, D Solenoid Circuit
45 24 General Failure, I Solenoid Circuit
45 26 General Failure, C Solenoid Circuit

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual

NOTE: Intermittent connections or lack of battery-direct power and ground connections may cause this and
other codes.

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, read Paragraph 4–1. Also, measure battery and ECU input voltages.

PROBING THE CONNECTOR

When testing the control system with the internal harness connected, the resistance of each solenoid can be
checked using a VOM.

B. Troubleshooting:

1. Inspect the valve body connector and make sure it is tightly connected. Clean or replace as
necessary (Appendix C).

2. If the connector is connected, clean, and not damaged, test the solenoid circuit in the valve body
for opens. Refer to the system schematic and/or chart to identify wires in the internal harness
which are connected. If the open circuit is found, replace the faulty component (refer to the ap-
propriate transmission service manual), and eliminate the open. The fault may be in the solenoid
itself.

3. If the open is not found at the transmission connector, disconnect the transmission harness
connector at the ECU and inspect the terminals in the connector and the ECU for damage or
contamination. Clean or replace as necessary. If the terminals are satisfactory, test the wires of the
solenoid circuit in the transmission harness for continuity. If the open is found in one of the wires,
isolate and repair it. If this is not feasible, use a spare wire, if available, or provide a new wire
(St. Clair P/N 200153 may be used for this purpose). Refer to Appendix C for information on
connector/wire repair.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–43


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 45 XX—GENERAL SOLENOID FAILURE


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
(Figure 5–11)

4. If multiple code 45s occur (45 12, 45 13, 45 14, 45 15, 45 22, and 45 24), and wiring and solenoids
test okay, a common solenoid driver is probably failed open.

5. Replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the original (bad) ECU to
confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the problem recurs, reinstall the new ECU to complete
the repair.

6. If code 45 21 occurs repeatedly and the H/J solenoid and wiring test okay, the solenoid driver may
be failed open. Follow Step (5) above.

7. If codes 45 16, 45 23, and 45 26 occur repeatedly and solenoids and wiring test okay, the solenoid
driver may be failed open. Follow Step (5) above.

8. If the open is not found in either the transmission or the harness or the ECU drivers, the condition
must be intermittent.
9. Use a spare wire, if available, or provide a new wire (St. Clair P/N 200153 may be used for this
purpose) for the solenoid circuit indicated by the diagnostic code. Refer to Appendix C for infor-
mation on connector assembly/disassembly.
10. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the
original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works,
inspect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent
condition. If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.
11. If condition persists, remove the solenoid cover and closely inspect the solenoid and internal
harness for damage. Repair or replace as necessary (refer to the appropriate transmission service
manual).

5–44 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT


NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–45


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 46 XX—HI SIDE OVERCURRENT


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODESFAULT
PRESENT

T CONNECTOR
AY

ECU
GR
(BLUE)

K
AC
BL
BL
UE T16
T32

A
B T17 T1
UE
C BL
D

F
G

MAIN VALVE BODY ECU


A 102–T1 ORANGE
J
12 – 24Ω F
B 120–T4 WHITE F SOL
F T4
131–T21 BLUE G SOL
H T21
A 130–T17 YELLOW A,B SOL POWER
A T17
12 – 24Ω A 104–T7 WHITE
B A SOL
B T7
103–T5 GREEN B SOL
D T5
A 116*–T19 YELLOW
B E T19 C,D,E SOL POWER
C 101–T24 BLUE
G 12 – 24Ω B C SOL
A B P T24
12 – 24Ω B B 127–T23 WHITE D SOL
A M T23
D
12 – 24Ω A 129–T6 TAN E SOL
K T6
12 – 24Ω
B N
E
12 – 24Ω A
L
102–T1 ORANGE F,G,I SOL POWER
G T1
130–T17 YELLOW
C

SEE NOTE
LOCKUP BODY
A 121–T2 TAN K SOL POWER
A T2
12 – 24Ω K B 128–T20 ORANGE
B T20 K SOL

LOW-RANGE or
TRIM BOOST BODY
A 102–T1 ORANGE
8610, 9810 LOCK IN D
RANGE MODELS ONLY I B 111–T8 GREEN
12 – 24Ω C T8 I SOL

A 107–T3 GREEN H or J SOL POWER


A T3
5610, 6610, 9610 MODELS
J B 110–T22 WHITE
10–13Ω 12–24Ω B T22 H or J SOL

A
J SOLENOID A NOTE: These wires may pass through a bulkhead connector.
8610 MODEL
CONNECTOR 12 – 24Ω H B
B *Wire designation may include a letter suffix which indicates
See Appendix B For a splice to the same number wire. See wiring schematic in
Detailed Terminal Location. Appendix G for more detail on splice letter designations.

L06600

Figure 5–12. Code 46 Schematic Drawing

5–46 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 46 XX—HI SIDE OVERCURRENTCODES


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC FAULTPRESENT
(Figure 5–12)

Main code 46 indicates that an overcurrent condition exists in one of the switches sending power to the
transmission control solenoids.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


46 21 High side overcurrent, H/J solenoid circuit
46 26 High side overcurrent, C, D, E solenoid circuit
46 27 High side overcurrent, A, B, F, G, I, K solenoid circuit

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual

B. Troubleshooting:
1. Probable cause is a wiring problem. A solenoid wire is probably shorted to ground or the solenoid
has a shorted coil which would cause an overcurrent condition. May also be an ECU problem.
2. Follow the troubleshooting steps for code 45 XX.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–47


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 56TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC
XX—RANGE VERIFICATION RATIO CODES
TEST (BETWEEN
PRESENTSHIFTS)
Main code 56 indicates either a failed Range verification speed sensor ratio test or a failed Neutral verification
speed sensor ratio test.

The Range ratio test occurs after a shift and determines if a clutch has lost torque carrying capability. If the output
speed is above a programmed output speed for a range, but the correct speed sensor ratio is not present, the DO
NOT SHIFT response is commanded and a code (one of 56 11 to 56 88) is logged. A range that can carry the
torque without damage is commanded or attempted. Turbine and output speed sensor readings are used to calculate
the actual ratio that is compared to the commanded ratio. (Refer to Sections B and D below.)

The Neutral ratio test occurs when Neutral is selected. If a minimum turbine speed is not detected after Neutral is
selected, the DO NOT SHIFT response is commanded, code 56 99 is logged, and the shift selector will display a
flashing “cateye” (-/-) to warn the operator that the transmission may be in gear. (See Section C and D below.)

Main Code Subcode Meaning


56 11 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 1
56 22 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 2
56 33 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 3
56 44 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 4
56 55 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 5
56 66 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 6
56 77 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 7
56 88 Range verification ratio test (between shifts) 8
56 99 Neutral verification ratio test, N

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual

NOTE: When a code 22 16 (output speed fault) is also present, follow the troubleshooting sequence for code
22 16 first. After completing the 22 16 sequence, drive the vehicle to see if a code 56 XX recurs.

NOTE: Before troubleshooting, measure battery and ECU input voltages.

NOTE: Intermittent connections or lack of battery-direct power and ground connections may cause this and
other codes.

B. Troubleshooting 56 11 to 56 88 Codes:
Erratic shifting and intermittent 56xx codes have resulted from false output speed sensor readings. A
loose transmission output nut allows the output speed sensor pickup gear to slip giving false readings.

Remove the output speed sensor and be sure the pickup gear is tight by using a pry tool. If the gear
can be moved by hand, tighten the transmission output nut. Follow the output nut installation
procedures in the service manual.

5–48 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 56TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC
XX—RANGE VERIFICATION RATIO CODES
TEST (BETWEEN
PRESENTSHIFTS)
C. Troubleshooting 56 99 Codes:
Code 56 99 was introduced in J03 calibrations starting in January 2003. The presence of code
indicates low turbine speed when Neutral is selected. This indicates a “lock in range” condition to the
ECU.

The following have all been associated with this code:

• Main control valve body solenoid stuck open from debris allowing clutch to engage.
• Main control valve body shift valve stuck open from debris allowing clutch to engage.
• Broken turbine or splitter input shafts
• Faulty turbine speed sensor
• Damaged chassis harness to the turbine speed sensor.

D. General Troubleshooting 56 11 to 56 99 Codes:


1. After the transmission is at operating temperature, allow vehicle engine to idle on level ground for
3–4 minutes. Determine the transmission fluid level. If improper fluid level is found, correct as
necessary. Improper fluid level could be the cause of the code. Not enough or too much fluid may
produce inadequate clutch pressure.
2. This code requires accurate output and turbine speed readings. If there were no transmission prob-
lems detected, use the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool
and test speed sensor signals for noise (erratic signals) from low speed to high speed in the range
indicated by the code.
3. If a noisy sensor is found, test the resistance of the sensor (refer to the temperature variation chart
below) and its wiring for opens, shorts, and shorts-to-ground (refer to code 22 XX). Carefully in-
spect the terminals in the connectors for corrosion, contamination, or damage. Be sure the wiring
to the sensors is a properly twisted wire pair. Replace a speed sensor if its resistance is incorrect.
Isolate and repair any wiring problems. Use a twisted-pair if a new speed sensor circuit is
needed—Service Harness Twisted Pair P/N 200153 is available from St. Clair Technologies for
this purpose.

Current Resistance (Ohms) Former Resistance (Ohms)


Temp ˚F Temp ˚C
January, 2006 Before January, 2006
250 200 –40 –40
340 300 68 20
450 400 230 110

4. If no apparent cause for the code can be found, replace the turbine and output speed sensors (refer
to the appropriate transmission service manual for proper procedure).
5. If the condition persists, replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the
original (bad) ECU to confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the original ECU now works, in-
spect the ECU connectors for any corrosion or damage which may cause an intermittent condition.
If the original problem recurs, reinstall the replacement ECU.
6. Connect a pressure gauge and test main pressure. If the pressure is not adequate, the pump is
probably worn. Refer to the appropriate service manual for main pressure specifications.
7. If main pressure is adequate, test clutch pressure for the range indicated by following the
procedure in the appropriate service manual. The transmission range indicated by the trouble code
can be found by referring to the solenoid and clutch chart on the hydraulic schematic in

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–49


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 56TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC
XX—RANGE VERIFICATION RATIO CODES
TEST (BETWEEN
PRESENTSHIFTS)
Appendix F. Drive the vehicle or use Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000
diagnostic tool clutch test mode and test clutch pressure.
8. If a clutch is leaking pressure, remove the main control valve body and inspect for damaged valve
body gaskets and stuck or sticking valves (refer to the transmission service manual). If no
problems are found, replace the solenoids for the clutches used in the range indicated by the code.
9. If replacing solenoids does not correct the pressure problem, a worn clutch or worn piston seals are
probably the source of the pressure leak. Remove the transmission and repair or replace as
necessary (refer to the appropriate transmission service manual).

5–50 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL
CODE 65 00—ENGINE RATING
TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC HIGHPRESENT
CODES
Main code 65 indicates the vehicle’s engine horsepower/governor speed rating is too high. This code is set only
when computer-controlled engines are used. Code 65 means the engine computer is able to tell the transmission,
the engine horsepower and/or governor speed is beyond the transmission rating or does not match the transmission
shift calibration.

When a code 65 is set, no shifts out of neutral are allowed. It is possible the transmission calibration selected for
this engine is improper. Contact Allison Transmission for assistance in selecting a proper calibration.

If the engine is beyond transmission ratings, contact the vehicle OEM for correction.

This code cannot be cleared until the proper level engine is installed or the transmission is properly calibrated.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–51


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 66 TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC
00—SCI (SERIAL COMMUNICATION INTERFACE) FAULT (Figure 5–13)
CODES PRESENT

Y
A
R
G
ECU
S CONNECTOR
K
(BLACK)
C

UE
LA
B

BL

S16
S32
UE
BL
S17 S1

182–S12 GREEN
C
184–S29 BLACK J 1939
B
183–S13 RED
INTERFACE
A

A + SERIAL
COMMUNICATION
INTERFACE
B — (SCI)

142–S1 WHITE
SCI, HI S1 J A
DIAGNOSTIC
TOOL
151–S17 BLUE CONNECTOR
SCI, LO S17 K B

ECU

J 1939, SHIELD S12 DEUTSCH


PACKARD

J 1939, LO S29

E
J 1939, HI S13

ALT DIAGNOSTIC TOOL


SCI J CONNECTOR
Uses twisted pairs of wire DIAGNOSTIC TOOL
K (DEUTSCH)
CONNECTOR
(PACKARD)

See Appendix B For Detailed Terminal Location

V06601.00.01

Figure 5–13. Code 66 Schematic Drawing

5–52 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 66 00—SCI (SERIAL COMMUNICATION


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC INTERFACE)
CODES PRESENTFAULT

The datalink for the throttle position sensor (TPS) must have been recognized by autodetect or manually selected
using the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool (refer to Allison Transmission
publication GN3433EN, User’s Guide, for the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or CEC2 Pro-Link® 9000
User’s Manual, GN2928EN) before these codes can be logged. See Paragraph 1–9 for further information.

Main code 66 indicates the ECU is expecting to get its throttle position signal across a serial communication
interface from a computer-controlled engine. Either the engine computer is not sending the throttle information or
the wiring between the engine and transmission computers has failed.

Code 66 00 can occur when the transmission ECU remains powered when the engine ECM is powered down. The
transmission sees this as a communication link failure.

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual
• Self-clearing

B. Troubleshooting:
1. Test for a throttle signal from the engine to the transmission, an engine computer malfunction, or
an engine throttle fault.

NOTE: Throttle position data sent from a computer-controlled engine may register a low number of counts on
Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool, but the counts will not change
as throttle percentage is changed.

2. Test wires 142 and 151 between the engine and transmission ECU for an open or short. Inspect all
connectors and make sure they are clean and tightly connected.

NOTE: These codes can also be set if J1939 communications fail. Test wires 183-S13, 184-S29, and 182-S12
for opens or shorts.

3. Use the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool to determine that
the ECU is receiving power when it should not.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 5–53


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CODE 69 XX—ECU MALFUNCTION


TROUBLESHOOTING—DIAGNOSTIC CODES PRESENT
Main code 69 indicates a problem which has been identified as being from within the ECU.

A “cateye” (-/-) display or a blank display may occur with subcode 33.

Main Code Subcode Meaning


69 27 ECU, Inoperative A, B, F, G, I, K solenoid switch
69 28 ECU, Inoperative H/J solenoid switch
69 29 ECU, Inoperative C, D, E solenoid switch
69 33 ECU, computer operating properly fault
69 34 ECU EEPROM, fault
69 35 ECU EEPROM, fault
69 39 Communication chip addressing error
69 42 SPI output failure
69 43 SPI input failure

A. Active Indicator Clearing Procedure:


• Power down
• Manual—except subcodes 33, 35, 42, and 43
• Self-clearing—subcode 42 and subcodes 33 and 35; after an ECU reset

NOTE: Subcode 34 cannot be cleared.

B. Troubleshooting:
1. For subcodes 27, 28, and 29, test for shorts to battery before replacing the ECU. Follow the
troubleshooting steps for code 45 XX for testing for shorts to battery. If no shorts are found,
replace the ECU. If replacing the ECU corrects the problem, reinstall the original (bad) ECU to
confirm that the problem is in the ECU. If the problem recurs, reinstall the new ECU to complete
the repair.
2. For all other subcodes, replace the ECU.

5–54 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SECTION 6—VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–1. ECU POWER

WIRE 136A 10A WIRE 336A


V-1 E1 J1
V
WIRE 136C WIRE 336C
V-16 E2 J2
VIM
+ –
ECU
+12V or +24V

V06676

Positive battery voltage must be supplied directly to the ECU from the battery positive terminal or a dedicated
“electronic” bus bar.
• These wires are connected through the VIM.
• Power is provided through a 10 amp fuse in the VIM.
• Wires must be kept as short as possible.
• No other loads can be added to these wires.
• Minimize the number of electrical connections between the ECU and battery to reduce the potential for
poor connections, corrosion, etc.
• Wires from the battery to the splice point before the VIM must be no smaller than 10 AWG. They may
need to be larger, depending on length.
— Wiring shall be sized to maintain a minimum of 10.5V at the ECU during max current draw
conditions (9 amp).

NOTE: Always remove all connectors from the ECU whenever welding on the vehicle.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 6–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–2. SYSTEM GROUNDS

WIRE 143A WIRE 343A


V-17 A1 K1
V
WIRE 143C WIRE 343C
V-32 A2 K2
VIM
– +
ECU
+12V or +24V

V06677

Ground must be supplied directly to the ECU from the battery negative terminal or a dedicated “electronic” bus
bar.
• These wires are connected through the VIM.
• Never use chassis grounds for these wires.
• If a power supply other than a battery is used, these wires must be connected directly to the negative
side of the power supply.
• Wires from the battery to the splice point before the VIM must be no smaller than 10 AWG. They may
need to be larger, depending on length.
— Wiring shall be sized to maintain a minimum of 10.5V at the ECU during max current draw
conditions (9 amp).

6–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–3. POWER AND GROUND USING A BUS BAR

WIRE 136A WIRE 336A BUS


V-1 E1 10A J1 BAR (+)
WIRE 136C WIRE 336C
V-16 E2 J2 Other vehicle
V electronic
WIRE 143A WIRE 343A devices
V-17 A1 K1
WIRE 143C WIRE 343C
V-32 A2 K2
VIM BUS
ECU BAR (–)

VEHICLE
ELECTRICAL
S SYSTEMS
– +
+12V or +24V

V06696

No additional electrical loads with high inductance (motors, solenoids, relays, etc.) may be added to the bus bars.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 6–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–4. INSTALLING A MASTER DISCONNECT SWITCH

WIRE 136A 10A WIRE 336A


V-1 E1 J1
If a “Master”disconnect
V switch is used,
WIRE 136C WIRE 336C
V-16 E2 J2 it must be located in
VIM this part of the circuit

ECU

S
– +
VEHICLE
ELECTRICAL
+12V or +24V SYSTEMS

V06678

If the vehicle is equipped with a master disconnect switch, the disconnect must be on the positive (power) side of
the system.

NOTE: Locating the master switch on the negative (ground) side of the system may result in the ECU being
powered at all times, even when the switch is in the off position, resulting in excessive battery drain.

6–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–5. IGNITION POWER

10A 10A
WIRE 146 WIRE 146
V-26 F1 C1 V-26 F1 C1
V V
VIM VIM

WIRE 346 WIRE 346

ECU IGNITION ECU


SWITCH
– + – +
IGNITION
SWITCH
+12V or +24V +12V or +24V
S S
ALTERNATE

V06679

Ignition power is wired through the VIM, via a 10 amp fuse.


• It can also be interfaced via the VIW-S connector.

Positive voltage should be supplied to the ECU when the vehicle ignition switch is turned on.
• The signal turns the ECU from its power-down state to on when the proper ECU parameters are met.
— At this point, the ECU reads calibration data in memory, checks all sensors for readiness, then
commands the control module to initialize the transmission and shift selector in neutral.
— Throttle position calibration is adjusted as necessary from stored data.

Ignition power can be either 12V or 24V.

NOTE: The ECU requires ignition input that is free of all unsuppressed inductive loads. Use a relay (refer to
Ignition Power-Alternate diagram) when any inductive loads exist in the feed to wire 146 or wire 346.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 6–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–6. CHECK TRANS LIGHT

DASH
INDICATOR
LIGHT
CHECK SWITCHED
V TRANS 12V or 24V

NC
ECU
COM NO
WIRE 115
S-31 IGNITION

CUSTOMER-FURNISHED
S RELAY
Relay shown
de-energized

V06680

Wire 115 goes from ground to open when the ECU senses a major transmission problem.
• An external relay is required if the current is 0.5 amps or greater.
• Do not use this signal in a vehicle shut-down system.

6–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–7. NEUTRAL START

V
WIRE 323 CM
V-6 G1
To neutral
NC start circuit
WIRE 323 NO
ECU COM F1
NO
WIRE 123
D1 GROUND

VIM
S
CUSTOMER-FURNISHED RELAY
Relay shown de-energized

V06681

Wire 123 enables the Neutral Start circuit.


• Wire 123 goes from open to positive voltage when Neutral has been selected and attained.
• Wire 123 is interfaced through the VIM.
— This signal is used with a relay in the VIM to verify that the transmission is in neutral for starting the
engine.
• The relay contact circuit must be protected by a customer-furnished 15 amp fuse.
• Voltage during engine cranking must not fall below the relay drop-out voltage.
• This feature cannot be used for interfacing with auxiliary vehicle systems which require neutral
indication.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 6–7


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–8. SPEEDOMETER SIGNAL

+ GND
SWITCHED
V V 12V or 24V AUX SIG
WIRE 157 WIRE
V-20 B2 H2
357UF
VIM
SPEEDOMETER

ECU ECU
+ GND
SWITCHED
12V or 24V AUX SIG WIRE 157
S S S-30
SPEEDOMETER

V06682

The voltage pulse signal conforms to a 50 percent (non-zero crossing) duty cycle square wave.
• The number of pulses per output shaft revolution may vary by model.
• The signal can be used directly by the speedometer or signal converter.
• Do not splice into the transmission harness to access speed sensor signals.

6–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–9. REVERSE WARNING

V
WIRE 313 CM
V-4 B1
To reverse
NC warning device
WIRE 313 NO
ECU COM A1
NO
WIRE 113
F2 GROUND

VIM
S
CUSTOMER-FURNISHED
RELAY
Relay shown de-energized

V06683

This interface enables the Reverse Warning indicator circuit.


• When the ECU commands reverse, wire 113 goes from open to ground.
• This signal can be used with an external relay for warning devices, backup lights, etc.
— A reverse warning relay is provided in the VIM.
— The relay’s contact circuit must be protected by a customer-furnished 15 amp fuse.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 6–9


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–10. SHIFT SELECTOR / DISPLAY DIMMER

FROM DASH DIMMER FROM DASH DIMMER


(12V) (24V)
DASH DASH
LIGHTS LIGHTS

V V

WIRE 187 WIRE 186


ECU U “KEYPAD” ECU T “KEYPAD”
WIRE 186 PUSHBUTTON PUSHBUTTON
T OR WIRE 188 OR
V
LEVER SHIFT LEVER SHIFT
WIRE 188 SELECTOR SELECTOR
S V S

For Shift Selector wiring requirements, For Shift Selector wiring requirements,
see installation drawing AS07-024, -025, or -026 see installation drawing AS07-024, -025, or -026
V06684

This interface supplies a variable input signal to the ECU through the vehicle’s dash dimmer control.
• Lighting configuration vary depending on shifter type.

Pushbutton selector:
• Digital display—variable
• MODE button backlighting—variable
• Pushbuttons—infinitely variable

Lever selector:
• Digital display—variable
• MODE button backlighting—infinitely variable
• Selectable ranges—no backlighting

6–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–11. SERIAL COMMUNICATION INTERFACE (SCI)—J1587/J1708

ECU ELECTRONIC
ENGINE
CONTROLS
WIRE 142
S-1 A (+) Wires 142 and 151 are a
S “TWISTED PAIR”.
WIRE 151 See installation drawing.
S-17 B (–)

V06685

SCI conforms to Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE) data interchange protocols J1587 and 1708.
• SCI is accomplished through an optional SCI connector on the Selector (S) harness.
• This interface communicates at 9600 bits per second.

Consult the engine manufacturer for appropriate engine-side installation instructions.

The Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool and Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool communicate with the ECU over the
SCI per SAE J1587.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 6–11


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

VEHICLE INTERFACE WIRING—MANDATORY (VIW-M)

6–12. COMMUNICATION INTERFACE—SAE J1939

ELECTRONIC
ENGINE
ECU CONTROLS
WIRE 183
S-13 (+)
WIRE 182
S-12 (s)
S
WIRE 184
S-29 (–)

V06686

SAE J1939 is a high speed communication interface capable of 250,000 bits per second.
• This interface’s higher speed improves system interactions due to the “real time” distribution and
sharing of data between control systems.

Interface is accomplished through a dedicated three-pin connector on the Selector (S) harness.

6–12 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SECTION 7—WIRING SCHEMATICS


OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

7–1. CALIBRATION COMPATIBILITY

Table 7–1. Release History (Last Update November 1, 2005)


CC Level* Software Level Date
J00 J00 January 2000
J00 J02 September 2001
J03 J06 January 2003
J06 J06 November 2004
J07, J08 J08 October 2005

* NOTE: The calibration compatibility (CC) level is used with the listed software level.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

7–2. INPUT FUNCTIONS

Table 7–2. Input Function Software Compatibility


Software Level
Function Description J00/J02 J03 J06 J08
1 Secondary Shift Schedule X X X X
5 Two-Speed Axle Enable X X X X
8 Hold-in-Range X X X X
9 D-1 Selection X X X X
11 Stall Check X X X X
14* Manual Lockup (non-roading) X X X X
16 Shift Selector Transition X X X X
17 Neutral-to-Range Inhibit X X X X
20 Anti-Lock Brake Response X X X
25 Quick-to-Neutral X X
29* Manual Lockup Enable (non-roading) X X
29 Automatic Lockup Off X X
29A Automatic Lockup Off X X
34 Retarder Enable (With VIM) X X X X
34 Retarder Enable (Without VIM) X X X X
52 Park Brake Enable X X
52A Load Dump Brake Enable X X
53 Delta-p (ΔP) Hold X X X X
54 R1 and R2 With Single Reverse Shift Selector X X X X
55 Manual Mode X X X X
56 Bed Hoist Interlock X X X X
58 Alternate Shift Selector With Manual Mode X X X
62 Engine Speed/torque Control (TSC1) X X X
63 Special Function Override #1 (Power) X X X
64 Special Function Override #1 (Ground) X X X

* NOTE: Input Function 14 used with Input Function 29 (refer to wiring schematics)

7–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

1. SECONDARY SHIFT SCHEDULE⎯ALSO REFER TO OUTPUT 16;


SECONDARY MODE INDICATOR

USES: Provides operator selection of dual shift schedules.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

WIRE 126
SECONDARY SHIFT SCHEDULE DASH SWITCH
V OPEN: PRIMARY
CLOSED: SECONDARY
WIRE 143
SIGNAL RETURN
S-28 OPTIONAL
VEHICLE
S-32 INTERFACE This function may be activated
ECU WIRING by either the MODE button NOTE: The shift schedule identified as
CONNECTOR or by the external circuit. “secondary” is activated when the switch is
closed or the MODE button is selected.
S If this function is on the MODE button, the
R MODE
primary mode will always be selected when
N the ECU is powered up.

ECU and Shift Selector D If this function is controlled by a dash switch,


are available from For Shift Selector the selection of primary/secondary mode is
Allison Transmission. wiring requirements, determined, at all times, by the position of
Other items must be see installation the dash switch.
sourced separately. drawing AS00-166 V09824.00.00

Figure 7–1. Secondary Shift Schedule

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

5. TWO SPEED AXLE INPUT⎯ALSO SHOWN: OUTPUT 18, TWO SPEED AXLE
OUTPUT

USES: Provides output speed interlock for axle engagement, input to ECU, and input to speedometer to adjust for
axle ratio change.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Output speed to activate, output speed to deactivate

VOCATIONS: Dump truck, on/off-highway truck, crash truck, crane

SWITCHED NOTE: If the axle actuator is an inductive load,


POWER it must be diode suppressed.
WIRE 153
V-12 Low High
TWO-SPEED Axle Axle
V V-31 AXLE INPUT
(TO ECU) TWO-SPEED HIGH
V-19 AXLE SWITCH
LOW
V-20 WIRE 161
SIGNAL RETURN AUX + GND
ECU
OPTIONAL NC
VEHICLE SIG GND AXLE
INTERFACE ACTUATOR
WIRING COM NO
CONNECTOR WIRE 105 SWITCHED
S SPEEDOMETER
TWO-SPEED AXLE ENABLE POWER
(FROM ECU) RELAY SHOWN
S-30 DE-ENERGIZED
WIRE 157
OPTIONAL SPEEDOMETER SIGNAL
SPEED SIGNAL (FROM ECU) ECU and Shift Selector are
REFER TO TEXT (SECTION C) available from Allison Transmission.
FOR REQUIRED CONNECTION Other items must be sourced separately. V09825.00.00

Figure 7–2. Two Speed Axle Input and Output

7–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
These schematics
have been show
validated the configuration
in the intended use ofshown.
the specified controls or
Any miswiring features
use ofwhich
these
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring
features which differs from that shown could cause unscheduled operationor use of of
these
the
features
PTO or other unpredictable operation resulting in damage to equipment or
which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment
WARNING! property,
or
property, personal
personal injury,
injury, or
or loss
loss of
of life.
life. ALLISON
ALLISON TRANSMISSION
TRANSMISSION IS IS NOT
NOT
LIABLE
LIABLE FORFOR THE
THE CONSEQUENCES
CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED ASSOCIATED WITH WITH MISWIRING
MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES. FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

8. HOLD IN RANGE

USES: Provide a discrete input to hold the transmission in present range.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

MOMENTARY
ECU WIRE 163 SWITCH NOTE: Transmission will continue to operate
S-27 with normal downshift schedule when
HOLD IN RANGE
function is active.
WIRE 143 Upshifts will occur per the programmed
S-32
S SIGNAL RETURN “HOLD UPSHIFT” shift schedule.
OPTIONAL OPEN: FUNCTION IS DE-ACTIVATED
VEHICLE ECU is available from
Allison Transmission. CLOSED: FUNCTION IS ACTIVATED
INTERFACE
WIRING Other items must be
CONNECTOR sourced separately.
V09826.00.00

Figure 7–3. Hold In Range

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

9. D1 SELECT

USES: Provides a convenient means to attain a programmed hold range for pushbutton shift selectors. Primary
and Secondary modes may be programmed separately.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Range selected with MODE button in Primary mode. Range selected with MODE
button in Secondary mode (usually 1st range).

VOCATIONS: Various

D1 SELECT
WIRE 126 (CHANGE OF STATE)
D1 SELECT
V DASH SWITCH
WIRE 143
SIGNAL RETURN NOTE: “Change of state” is defined as any
selection on the shift selector or changed
S-28 OPTIONAL state (open-to-closed, or closed-to-open)
VEHICLE of the “D1 Select” switch, if applicable.
S-32 INTERFACE This function may be activated
ECU WIRING by either the MODE button
CONNECTOR or by the external circuit.

S R MODE

ECU and Shift Selector N


are available from D For Shift Selector
Allison Transmission. wiring requirements,
Other items must be see installation
sourced separately. drawing AS00-166 V09827.00.00

Figure 7–4. D1 Select

7–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

11. STALL CHECK

USES: Provides a means of selecting a programmed gear for determining engine speed at converter stall.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

This function is for diagnostic purposes only and must not be activated during
WARNING! normal vehicle operation.

DASH
SWITCH
WIRE 118 SWITCHED
V-13 POWER
STALL CHECK
OPEN: NORMAL OPERATING MODE
V OPTIONAL
VEHICLE CLOSED: STALL CHECK MODE
INTERFACE
WIRING
CONNECTOR
To switch between normal
ECU and stall check modes,
transmission must be in neutral,
output speed below 60 rpm,
R MODE
and throttle at near-zero position.
N
S
D
ECU and Shift Selectors
are available from For Shift Selector
Allison Transmission. wiring requirements,
Other items must be see installation
sourced separately. drawing AS00-166 V09828.00.00

Figure 7–5. Stall Check

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–7


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

14. MANUAL LOCKUP⎯ALSO SHOWN: INPUT 29, MANUAL LOCKUP ENABLE

USES: Provides for the manual application of the lockup clutch for non-roading applications. Uses two inputs;
one to select manual versus automatic lockup shift mode, and the second as the switching mechanism to
command the lockup clutch on and off.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Oil field pumping, mud pumps, hoists, drilling, trenchers

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

SWITCH 1
AUTOMATIC/MANUAL LOCKUP
WIRE 154
V-27
MANUAL LOCKUP ENABLE

V V-31 WIRE 161


SIGNAL RETURN SWITCH 2
WIRE 155 LOCKUP ON/LOCKUP OFF
V-11
MANUAL LOCKUP
ECU OPTIONAL
VEHICLE INTERFACE OPERATING PROCEDURE
WIRING CONNECTOR
SWITCH 1 SWITCH 2
NOTE: This function must NOT be OPEN OPEN Normal Auto Lockup Operation
S used when the transmission is used OPEN CLOSED Normal Auto Lockup Operation
ECU is available from for vehicle propulsion. To control
Allison Transmission. lockup clutch engagement during CLOSED OPEN Converter Operation Only
Other items must be roading operation, see CLOSED CLOSED Lockup Operation Only
sourced separately. Function 29-Automatic Lockup Off.
V04875.01.00

Figure 7–6. Manual Lockup

7–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
Thesebeen
have schematics show
validated the configuration
in the intended use of the specified
shown. controls or
Any miswiring features
use ofwhich
these
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring
features which differs from that shown could cause unintended selection or use of
ofrange
these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! or other unpredictable operation resulting in damage to equipment or property,
property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT LIABLE
LIABLE
FOR THEFOR THE CONSEQUENCES
CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATEDASSOCIATEDWITHWITH MISWIRING
MISWIRING OR
OR UNINTENDED USE OF
UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

16. SHIFT SELECTOR TRANSITION

USES: When two shift selectors are used, to select which one is active.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

DASH
SWITCH
WIRE 118 SWITCHED
V-13 POWER
SHIFT SELECTOR TRANSITION
OPEN: PRIMARY
V OPTIONAL CLOSED: SECONDARY
VEHICLE
INTERFACE
WIRING When ECU is turned ON,
CONNECTOR active SHIFT SELECTOR
SELECTOR SELECTOR is determined by current
ECU 1 2 switch position.

Display of the
inactive selector is disabled.
S To switch between
R MODE
R MODE
SELECTOR 1 and SELECTOR 2,
N N transmission must be in
ECU and Shift Selectors NEUTRAL and output speed
are available from For Shift Selector D D below 60 rpm.
Allison Transmission. wiring requirements,
Other items must be see installation
sourced separately. drawing AS00-166

V09830.00.00

Figure 7–7. Shift Selector Transition

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–9


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These
These schematics
schematics show
show the
the intended
intended use
use of
of the
the specified
specified controls
controls features
features which
which
have
have been
been validated
validated in
in the
the configuration
configuration shown.
shown. Any
Any miswiring
miswiring or
or use
use of
of these
these
features
features which
whichdiffers
differsfrom
fromthatthatshown
showncould
couldcause unintended
result in damageselection of range
to equipment or
WARNING!
WARNING! or other unpredictable
property, operation
personal injury, or lossresulting in damageTRANSMISSION
of life. ALLISON to equipment or property,
IS NOT
personal
LIABLE injury,
FOR THEor loss of life. ALLISON ASSOCIATED
CONSEQUENCES TRANSMISSION IS NOT
WITH LIABLE
MISWIRING
FOR THE CONSEQUENCES
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE ASSOCIATED
FEATURES. WITH MISWIRING OR
UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

17. NEUTRAL TO RANGE INHIBIT

USES: Holds transmission in NEUTRAL regardless of the range position of the shift selector.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

WIRE 137
V-29 NEUTRAL-TO-RANGE INHIBIT
V
WIRE 161
V-31
SIGNAL RETURN
OPTIONAL Typically indicates status of
ECU VEHICLE vehicle park brake system
INTERFACE OPEN: PARK BRAKE APPLIED
WIRING CLOSED: PARK BRAKE NOT APPLIED
CONNECTOR

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09831.00.00

Figure 7–8. Neutral To Range Inhibit

7–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

20. ANTI-LOCK BRAKE RESPONSE

USES: Provides for enhanced control of the transmission lockup clutch and retarder during hard braking
conditions. Can be used separately of in conjunction with ABS.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: On/Off-highway trucks, oil field service vehicles

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

NO ABS ABS INPUT (—) ABS INPUT (+)


WIRE 161 WIRE 161 WIRE 161
* BRAKE * BRAKE
SIGNAL RETURN PRESSURE PRESSURE
* BRAKE SWITCH SWITCH
V V-31
PRESSURE — OR — — OR —
SWITCH NC NC
V-27 WIRE 177 WIRE 177
ECU COM NO COM NO
OPTIONAL WIRE 177 SWITCHED
VEHICLE ABS RESPONSE POWER
INTERFACE
WIRING RELAY IS SHOWN RELAY IS SHOWN
S CONNECTOR DE-ENERGIZED DE-ENERGIZED

ANTI-LOCK ANTI-LOCK
BRAKE CONTROLS BRAKE CONTROLS
ECU is available from
Allison Transmission. This configuration is to be used This configuration is to be used
Other items must be if the ABS system provides a if the ABS system provides a
sourced separately. power (–) signal when active. power (+) signal when active.

* NOTE: Brake Pressure Switch is closed when brakes are applied.


Switch pressure setting to be established by customer evaluation (typically 30–35 psi). V09832.00.00

Figure 7–9. Anti-Lock Brake Response

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–11


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

25. QUICK TO NEUTRAL

USES: Automatically shifts transmission to NEUTRAL when function is activated.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Oil field pumping, trenchers, augers

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

QUICK-TO-NEUTRAL
SWITCH
WIRE 178 SWITCHED
V V-28 POWER
QUICK-TO-NEUTRAL
OPTIONAL OPEN: NORMAL TRANSMISSION OPERATION
VEHICLE CLOSED: TRANSMISSION IS SHIFTED AND HELD
INTERFACE IN NEUTRAL REGARDLESS OF SHIFT
ECU WIRING SELECTOR POSITION
CONNECTOR

NOTE: To re-engage transmission, NEUTRAL must be


selected before selecting a DRIVE range.

S NOTE: This function must NOT be used when the


transmission is used for vehicle propulsion.
ECU is available from
Allison Transmission.
Other items must be
sourced separately. V09833.00.00

Figure 7–10. Quick To Neutral

7–12 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

29. MANUAL LOCKUP ENABLE (ALSO SHOWN: INPUT 14, MANUAL LOCKUP)
(NON-ROADING)

USES: Provides for the manual application of the lockup clutch for non-roading applications. Uses two inputs:
one to select manual versus automatic lockup shift mode, and the second as the switching mechanism to
command the lockup clutch on and off.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Oil field pumping, mud pumps, hoists, drilling, trenchers

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

SWITCH 1
AUTOMATIC/MANUAL LOCKUP
WIRE 154
V-27
MANUAL LOCKUP ENABLE

V V-31 WIRE 161


SIGNAL RETURN SWITCH 2
WIRE 155 LOCKUP ON/LOCKUP OFF
V-11
MANUAL LOCKUP
ECU OPTIONAL
VEHICLE INTERFACE OPERATING PROCEDURE
WIRING CONNECTOR
SWITCH 1 SWITCH 2
NOTE: This function must NOT be OPEN OPEN Normal Auto Lockup Operation
S used when the transmission is used OPEN CLOSED Normal Auto Lockup Operation
ECU is available from for vehicle propulsion. To control
Allison Transmission. lockup clutch engagement during CLOSED OPEN Converter Operation Only
Other items must be roading operation, see CLOSED CLOSED Lockup Operation Only
sourced separately. Function 29-Automatic Lockup Off.
V04875.01.00

Figure 7–11. Manual Lockup Enable

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–13


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

29. AUTOMATIC LOCKUP OFF

USES: Provides for disengagement of the lockup clutch for vehicle roading applications. Used primarily as a
means to disable the lockup clutch and keep the transmission in “converter mode” for specialized types of
low-speed operation and/or emergency situations.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Dump truck, on/off-highway truck

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

SWITCH 1
AUTOMATIC/MANUAL LOCKUP
WIRE 154
V-27 AUTOMATIC LOCKUP OFF
(MANUAL LOCKUP ENABLE)
V
WIRE 161
V-31
SIGNAL RETURN
ECU OPTIONAL
VEHICLE
INTERFACE
WIRING OPERATING PROCEDURE
CONNECTOR
SWITCH

S OPEN Normal Automatic


Lockup Operation

CLOSED Converter Operation Only


ECU is available from Allison Transmission.
Other items must be sourced separately. V09834.00.00

Figure 7–12. Automatic Lockup Off

7–14 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

29A. AUTOMATIC LOCKUP OFF

USES: Provides for disengagement of the lockup clutch for vehicle roading applications. Used primarily as a
means to disable the lockup clutch and keep the transmission in “converter mode” for specialized types of
low-speed operation and/or emergency situations.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Dump truck, on/off-highway truck

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

SWITCH 1
AUTOMATIC/MANUAL LOCKUP
WIRE 154
V-27
MANUAL LOCKUP ENABLE

V V-31 WIRE 161


SIGNAL RETURN SWITCH 2
WIRE 155 LOCKUP ON/LOCKUP OFF
V-11
MANUAL LOCKUP
ECU OPTIONAL
VEHICLE INTERFACE OPERATING PROCEDURE
WIRING CONNECTOR
SWITCH 1 SWITCH 2
NOTE: This function must NOT be OPEN OPEN Normal Auto Lockup Operation
S used when the transmission is used OPEN CLOSED Normal Auto Lockup Operation
ECU is available from for vehicle propulsion. To control
Allison Transmission. lockup clutch engagement during CLOSED OPEN Converter Operation Only
Other items must be roading operation, see CLOSED CLOSED Lockup Operation Only
sourced separately. Function 29-Automatic Lockup Off.
V04875.01.00

Figure 7–13. Automatic Lockup Off

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–15


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

34. RETARDER ENABLE (WITH VIM)⎯ALSO SHOWN: OUTPUT 9, RETARDER


INDICATOR

USES: Used to signal the ECU that the retarder is requested, and to indicate that conditions are appropriate to
apply the retarder.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various vehicular applications

REQUEST DISABLE
SWITCH SWITCH
WIRE 178 SWITCHED
V-28
RETARDER ENABLE POWER
ACTIVATED BY ACCESSIBLE TO
V VEHICLE SYSTEM OPERATOR TO
SUCH AS DISABLE THE
RETARDER CONTROL RETARDER CIRCUIT TO VEHICLE SYSTEM
TYPICALLY USED TO
V-18 ACTIVATE THE
ECU RETARDER SYSTEM,
OPTIONAL OPTIONAL VIM RETARDER LIGHT,
VEHICLE AND/OR ENGINE BRAKE
INTERFACE N.C.
WIRING WIRE 346 D1
C1 N.C.
S CONNECTOR(S) COM N.O.
WIRE 125
C2 COM N.O.
RETARDER INDICATOR WIRE 325

RELAY (REQUIRED) RELAY


ECU and VIM are available from Allison Transmission. IS SHOWN SHOWN
Other items must be sourced separately. DE-ENERGIZED DE-ENERGIZED V09835.00.00

Figure 7–14. Retarder Enable (With VIM)

7–16 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

34. RETARDER ENABLE (WITHOUT VIM)⎯ALSO SHOWN: OUTPUT 9, RETARDER


INDICATOR

USES: Used to signal the ECU that the retarder is requested, and to indicate that conditions are appropriate to
apply the retarder.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various vehicular applications

REQUEST DISABLE
SWITCH SWITCH
WIRE 178 SWITCHED
V-28 POWER
RETARDER ENABLE
ACTIVATED BY ACCESSIBLE TO
V VEHICLE SYSTEM OPERATOR TO
SUCH AS DISABLE THE
RETARDER CONTROL RETARDER CIRCUIT

V-18 TO VEHICLE SYSTEM


ECU (TYPICALLY USED TO
OPTIONAL ACTIVATE THE
VEHICLE RETARDER SYSTEM,
INTERFACE RETARDER LIGHT,
WIRING AND/OR ENGINE BRAKE
CONNECTOR(S)
N.C.
S COM N.O.
WIRE 125 SWITCHED
ECU is available from RETARDER INDICATOR POWER
Allison Transmission.
Other items must be RELAY SHOWN
sourced separately. DE-ENERGIZED V09836.00.00

Figure 7–15. Retarder Enable (Without VIM)

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–17


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

52. PARK BRAKE ENABLE (ALSO SHOWN: OUTPUT 31, PARK BRAKE OUTPUT)

USES: Turns on the park brake when the transmission is in neutral and output rpm is below a programmed speed.
Turns park brake off, after a programmed delay, when the transmission is shifted into a forward or reverse
range.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: 1. Time delay to release brake after a range (other than neutral) is selected.
2. Output speed below park brake is enabled.

VOCATIONS: Various vehicular applications

PARK BRAKE
ENABLE FUNCTION MATRIX
WIRE 155 Park Brake ECU Park Brake Status of
V-11 Enable (Switch) Logic Output Signal Park Brake
PARK BRAKE
ENABLE OPEN OFF OFF ON
OPEN ON OFF ON
V CLOSED OFF OFF ON
WIRE 161
V-31 CLOSED ON ON OFF
SIGNAL RETURN

ECU
TO PARK BRAKE
SYSTEM
NC In relay state shown
(de-energized),
park brake is applied
S COM NO
WIRE 176
S-15 SWITCHED
PARK BRAKE OUTPUT POWER
NOTE: This function is controlled by inverse
CUSTOMER-FURNISHED logic. When the park brake signal is on,
RELAY the park brake is released. With no power
Relay shown de-energized applied, the park brake is applied.
V06656

Figure 7–16. Park Brake Enable

7–18 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

52A. LOAD DUMP BRAKE ENABLE (ALSO SHOWN: OUTPUT 31A, LOAD DUMP
BRAKE OUTPUT)

USES: Turns on the load dump brake when the transmission is in neutral and output rpm is below a programmed
speed. Turns load dump brake off, after a programmed delay, when the transmission is shifted into a
forward or reverse range.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: 1. Time delay to release brake after a range (other than neutral) is selected.
2. Output speed below which load dump brake is enabled.

VOCATIONS: Various vehicular applications

FUNCTION MATRIX
WIRE 155 LOAD DUMP Load Dump Load Dump Status of
V-11 BRAKE ENABLE SWITCH Brake ECU Brake Load Dump
LOAD DUMP Enable (Switch) Logic Output Signal Brake
BRAKE ENABLE Closed: Brake is always off OPEN OFF OFF OFF
V Open: Brake apply is automatic OPEN ON ON ON
WIRE 161 as determined by ECU logic CLOSED OFF OFF OFF
V-31
SIGNAL RETURN CLOSED ON OFF OFF

ECU
TO BRAKE
SYSTEM
NC In relay state shown
(de-energized),
brake is not applied
S COM NO
WIRE 176
S-15 SWITCHED
LOAD DUMP POWER
BRAKE OUTPUT
CUSTOMER-FURNISHED
RELAY
Relay shown de-energized
V06688

Figure 7–17. Load Dump Brake Enable

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–19


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

53. ΔP (“DELTA-P”) HOLD

USES: Prevents transmission upshifts when main oil pressure ΔP pressure switch is closed.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

NOTE: Transmission will


WIRE 117 continue to operate with
V-30
ΔP HOLD normal downshift schedule
V NC when function is active.
WIRE 161 Upshifts will occur per the
V-31 programmed “HOLD UPSHIFT”
SIGNAL RETURN COM NO shift schedule.
OPTIONAL
VEHICLE INTERFACE
ECU WIRING CONNECTOR RELAY SHOWN
DE-ENERGIZED

NO SWITCHED
C A
ECU is available from B POWER
S Allison Transmission. COM
NC “FILTER OK”
ΔP switch is supplied
with the transmission FILTER ΔP SWITCH
on the main filter body. OPEN: FUNCTION IS DE-ACTIVATED
Other items must be CLOSED: FUNCTION IS ACTIVATED
sourced separatel. “CHANGE FILTER” V06689.01.00

Figure 7–18. ΔP (“Delta-P”) Hold

7–20 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

54. R1 AND R2 REVERSE OPERATION WITH SINGLE-REVERSE SHIFT


SELECTOR
USES: Provides for operation with alternate reverse ranges in an installation with a single-reverse shift selector.
VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None
VOCATIONS: Various

DASH SWITCH
WIRE 169 “ALTERNATE REVERSE” SWITCH
V ALTERNATE REVERSE OPEN: ECU COMMANDS R1
WHEN REVERSE IS SELECTED
WIRE 143 CLOSED: ECU COMMANDS R2
SIGNAL RETURN WHEN REVERSE IS SELECTED
S-26 OPTIONAL
VEHICLE
S-32 INTERFACE
ECU WIRING
CONNECTOR

S
R MODE

N
ECU and Shift Selector D
are available from For Shift Selector
Allison Transmission. wiring requirements,
Other items must be see installation
sourced separately. drawing AS00-166 V09838.00.00

Figure 7–19. R1 and R2 Reverse Operation With Single-Reverse Shift Selector

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–21


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

55. MANUAL MODE⎯ALSO REFER TO OUTPUT 32, MANUAL MODE INDICATOR

USES: Provides manual mode operation for service troubleshooting and non-vehicular (stationary) applications.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: All

OPTIONAL
VEHICLE
INTERFACE
WIRING DISABLE
ECU CONNECTOR SWITCH
WIRE 119 SWITCHED
S-11 POWER
MANUAL MODE
OPEN: NORMAL OPERATION
CLOSED: MANUAL MODE
S

ECU is available from


Allison Transmission.
Other items must be
sourced separately. V09839.00.00

Figure 7–20. Manual Mode

7–22 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These
These schematics
schematics show
show the
the intended
intended use
use of
of the
the specified
specified controls
controls features
features which
which
have
have been
been validated
validated in
in the
the configuration
configuration shown.
shown. Any
Any miswiring
miswiring or
or use
use of
of these
these
features
features which
which differs
differsfrom
fromthat
thatshown
showncould
couldcause unintended
result in damageselection of range
to equipment or
WARNING!
WARNING! or other unpredictable
property, operation
personal injury, or lossresulting in damageTRANSMISSION
of life. ALLISON to equipment or property,
IS NOT
personal
LIABLE injury,
FOR THEor loss of life. ALLISONASSOCIATED
CONSEQUENCES TRANSMISSION IS NOT
WITH LIABLE
MISWIRING
FOR THE CONSEQUENCES
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE ASSOCIATED
FEATURES. WITH MISWIRING OR
UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

56. BED HOIST INTERLOCK

USES: Shifts the transmission to NEUTRAL if the dump bed switch is opened when the transmission is in
REVERSE.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Rear dump truck

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

WIRE 177
V-14
BED HOIST INTERLOCK

V
WIRE 161
V-31
SIGNAL RETURN MOMENTARY SWITCH
OPTIONAL OPEN: SHIFT TO REVERSE IS INHIBITED
ECU VEHICLE CLOSED: SHIFT TO REVERSE IS PERMITTED
INTERFACE
WIRING
CONNECTOR

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09840.00.00

Figure 7–21. Bed Hoist Interlock

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–23


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

58. ALTERNATE SHIFT SELECTOR WITH MANUAL MODE

USES: Transfers shift control to secondary shift selector and converts shift calibration to manual mode. For use in
dual mode (vehicle and pump) applications.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Oil field dual mode

ECU DISABLE
SWITCH
WIRE 119 SWITCHED
S-11 POWER
ALTERNATE SHIFT SELECTOR
OPTIONAL WITH MANUAL MODE OPEN: NORMAL OPERATION
VEHICLE CLOSED: ALTERNATE SHIFT SELECTOR
S INTERFACE WITH MANUAL MODE
WIRING
CONNECTOR(S)

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09841.00.00

Figure 7–22. Alternate Shift Selector With Manual Mode

7–24 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

62. ENGINE SPEED / TORQUE CONTROL

USES: Sets engine speed or torque limits in specific ranges. Used to limit torque in lower ranges or maximum
vehicle speed in upper ranges.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Affected ranges, speed limits, torque limits

VOCATIONS: Various

If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
WARNING! into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

WIRE 153
V-12 ENGINE SPEED / TORQUE CONTROL
INPUT
V

V-31 WIRE 161


SIGNAL RETURN
OPTIONAL OPERATOR CONTROL
ECU VEHICLE TO ACTIVATE TORQUE
INTERFACE OR SPEED LIMITING
WIRING OPEN: FUNCTION IS DE-ACTIVATED
CONNECTOR CLOSED: FUNCTION IS ACTIVATED

ECU is available from


Allison Transmission.
Other items must be
sourced separately. V09837.00.00

Figure 7–23. Engine Speed / Torque Control

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–25


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

INPUT FUNCTION

63/64. SPECIAL FUNCTION OVERRIDE

USES: Disables selected input functions during emergency conditions.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Airport crash truck

This function is required for Crash Truck installations when any of the following
functions are included in the controls calibration:
1. Hold-in-Range
2. Neutral-to-Range Inhibit
WARNING! 3. Engine Speed / Torque Control
If this function is enabled in the shift calibration, the function MUST be integrated
into the vehicle wiring. If the function is available in the shift calibration but will
not be used in the vehicle, it MUST be disabled in the calibration.

WIRE 118
V-13 SWITCHED POWER
SPECIAL FUNCTION
OPTIONAL VEHICLE OVERRIDE NO. 1
V INTERFACE OPERATIONAL NOTE:
WIRING CONNECTORS
If both switches are open, function is ON. Programmed
functionality of Hold-in-Range, Neutral-to-Range-Inhibit,
and Engine speed/Torque control features are
ECU overridden and do not respond to their individual input.
WIRE 169 If both switches are closed, function is OFF.
S-26 SPECIAL FUNCTION
OVERRIDE NO. 2
If either switch is closed and the other is open for
WIRE 143 more than two minutes, an error code will be logged
S S-32 and functions Hold-in-Range, Neutral-to-Range-Inhibit,
SIGNAL RETURN
OPTIONAL VEHICLE and Engine Speed/Torque Control will function normally.
INTERFACE
WIRING CONNECTORS

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09843.00.00

Figure 7–24. Special Function Override

7–26 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

7–3. OUTPUT FUNCTION

Table 7–3. Output Function Software Compatibility


Software Level
Function Description J00/J02 J03 J06 J08
1 Lockup Indicator X X X X
4 Range Commanded Indicator X X X X
5 Output Speed Indicator A X X X X
6 Output Speed Indicator B X X X X
7 Engine Overspeed Indicator X X X X
9 Retarder Indicator (with VIM) X X X X
9 Retarder Indicator (without VIM) X X X X
16 Secondary Mode Indicator X X X X
18 Two-speed Axle Output X X X X
31 Park Brake Output X X
31 Neutral-to-Range Brake Output X X
31A Load Dump Brake Output X X
32 Manual Mode Indicator X X X X
34 Alternate Speed/Torque Control Select for Garage Shift X X X
40 Engine Speed/Torque Control Indicator X X X

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–27


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

1. LOCKUP INDICATOR

USES: Turn on dash indicator when transmission lockup clutch is engaged. Used to indicate when maximum
engine braking is available.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

SWITCHED
POWER
Contacts close when torque converter lockup
V clutch is applied in the transmission.
V-3 OPTIONAL VIM
OPTIONAL NC
VEHICLE WIRE 346 WIRE 332
ECU E2 E3
INTERFACE COM NO
WIRING WIRE 132
CONNECTOR B1
LOCKUP INDICATOR
TRANSMISSION
LOCKUP
S
RELAY (REQUIRED)
IS SHOWN
DE-ENERGIZED
ECU and VIM are available from Allison Transmission.
Other items must be sourced separately. V09844.00.00

Figure 7–25. Lockup Indicator

7–28 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

4. RANGE SELECTED/COMMANDED INDICATOR

USES: Used with auxiliary vehicle systems to permit operation only in specified transmission range(s).

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Range or ranges to be indicated

VOCATIONS: Various

SWITCHED
POWER OPTIONAL VIM
N.C.
WIRE 314 WIRE 314
V A2 A3
COM N.O.
WIRE 346
C1
AUXILIARY
WIRE 114 VEHICLE
V-2 F3
ECU RANGE INDICATOR SYSTEM
OPTIONAL RELAY (REQUIRED)
VEHICLE IS SHOWN
INTERFACE DE-ENERGIZED
WIRING
CONNECTOR
S

ECU and VIM are available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09845.00.00

Figure 7–26. Range Commanded Indicator

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–29


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

5. OUTPUT SPEED INDICATOR⎯A

USES: To signal that the transmission output shaft has exceeded a specified value.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Rpm to turn ON output and to turn OFF output. The ON value must be higher than
the OFF value.

VOCATIONS: Various

SWITCHED
V POWER
V-5

OPTIONAL
VEHICLE TRANSMISSION
INTERFACE N.C.
ECU OR VEHICLE
WIRING PROGRAMMED
CONNECTOR COM N.O.
WIRE 167 SPEED
OUTPUT SPEED INDICATOR
INDICATOR A
CUSTOMER-FURNISHED
S RELAY SHOWN
DE-ENERGIZED

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09846.00.00

Figure 7–27. Output Speed Indicator—A

7–30 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

6. OUTPUT SPEED INDICATOR—B

USES: To signal that the transmission output shaft has exceeded a specified value.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Rpm to turn ON output and to turn OFF output. The ON value must be higher than
the OFF value.

VOCATIONS: Various

SWITCHED
POWER
V
V-19 TRANSMISSION
N.C.
OR VEHICLE
OPTIONAL COM N.O. PROGRAMMED
VEHICLE WIRE 167 SPEED
ECU INTERFACE INDICATOR
OUTPUT SPEED
WIRING INDICATOR B
CONNECTOR CUSTOMER-FURNISHED
RELAY IS SHOWN
DE-ENERGIZED

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09847.00.00

Figure 7–28. Output Speed Indicator—B

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–31


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

7. ENGINE OVERSPEED INDICATOR

USES: To turn on dash light when engine reaches an overspeed condition.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Rpm to turn ON; rpm to turn OFF.

VOCATIONS: Various

RELAY (REQUIRED)
IS SHOWN
SWITCHED DE-ENERGIZED
POWER
OPTIONAL VIM
V
N.C.
WIRE 312 WIRE 312
F2 F3
COM N.O.
WIRE 112
V-22 D2
ECU ENGINE
OVERSPEED WIRE 343 ENGINE
OPTIONAL INDICATOR K1
OVERSPEED
VEHICLE
INTERFACE
WIRING Contacts close when
CONNECTOR engine speed exceeds
S BATTERY a calibration value.
GROUND
Contacts open when
engine speed falls below
a lower calibration value.
ECU and VIM are available from Allison Transmission.
Other items must be sourced separately. V09848.00.00

Figure 7–29. Engine Overspeed Indicator

7–32 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

9. RETARDER INDICATOR (WITH VIM)⎯ALSO SHOWN: INPUT 34, RETARDER

USES: Signals that the retarder is active. Typically used to turn on the vehicle brake lights and dash-mounted
indicator light when the retarder is in use.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

REQUEST DISABLE
SWITCH SWITCH
WIRE 178 SWITCHED
V-28
RETARDER ENABLE POWER
ACTIVATED BY ACCESSIBLE TO
V VEHICLE SYSTEM OPERATOR TO
SUCH AS DISABLE THE
RETARDER CONTROL RETARDER CIRCUIT TO VEHICLE SYSTEM
TYPICALLY USED TO
V-18 ACTIVATE THE
ECU RETARDER SYSTEM,
OPTIONAL OPTIONAL VIM RETARDER LIGHT,
VEHICLE AND/OR ENGINE BRAKE
INTERFACE N.C.
WIRING WIRE 346 D1
C1 N.C.
S CONNECTOR(S) COM N.O.
WIRE 125
C2 COM N.O.
RETARDER INDICATOR WIRE 325

RELAY (REQUIRED) RELAY


ECU and VIM are available from Allison Transmission. IS SHOWN SHOWN
Other items must be sourced separately. DE-ENERGIZED DE-ENERGIZED V09835.00.00

Figure 7–30. Retarder Indicators (With VIM)

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–33


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

9. RETARDER INDICATOR (WITHOUT VIM)⎯ALSO SHOWN: INPUT 34, RETARDER

USES: Signals that the retarder is active. Typically used to turn on the vehicle brake lights and dash-mounted
indicator light when the retarder is in use.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

REQUEST DISABLE
SWITCH SWITCH
WIRE 178 SWITCHED
V-28 POWER
RETARDER ENABLE
ACTIVATED BY ACCESSIBLE TO
V VEHICLE SYSTEM OPERATOR TO
SUCH AS DISABLE THE
RETARDER CONTROL RETARDER CIRCUIT

V-18 TO VEHICLE SYSTEM


ECU TYPICALLY USED TO
OPTIONAL ACTIVATE THE
VEHICLE RETARDER SYSTEM,
INTERFACE RETARDER LIGHT,
WIRING AND/OR ENGINE BRAKE
CONNECTOR(S)
N.C.
S COM N.O.
WIRE 125 SWITCHED
ECU is available from RETARDER INDICATOR POWER
Allison Transmission.
Other items must be RELAY SHOWN
sourced separately. DE-ENERGIZED V09875.00.00

Figure 7–31. Retarder Indicators (Without VIM)

7–34 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

16. SECONDARY MODE INDICATOR⎯ALSO REFER TO INPUT 1, SECONDARY


SHIFT SCHEDULE

USES: To indicate that Secondary Mode is active.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

If current in lamp circuit


exceeds 0.5 amp, ground NC
lamp through a relay. SECONDARY
MODE COM NO
V SWITCHED
POWER
WIRE 166
SECONDARY MODE INDICATOR
ECU

WIRE 166 SECONDARY SWITCHED


S-18 POWER
SECONDARY MODE INDICATOR MODE
S
OPTIONAL
VEHICLE INTERFACE
WIRING CONNECTOR

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09876.00.00

Figure 7–32. Secondary Mode Indicator

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–35


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

18. TWO-SPEED AXLE OUTPUT⎯ALSO SHOWN: INPUT 5, TWO-SPEED AXLE


INPUT)

USES: Signals that conditions are acceptable for low speed axle operation. Use in conjunction with Two-Speed
Axle input function.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

SWITCHED NOTE: If the axle actuator is an inductive load,


POWER it must be diode suppressed.
WIRE 153
V-12 Low High
TWO-SPEED Axle Axle
V V-31 AXLE INPUT
(TO ECU) TWO-SPEED HIGH
V-19 AXLE SWITCH
LOW
V-20 WIRE 161
SIGNAL RETURN AUX + GND
ECU
OPTIONAL NC
VEHICLE SIG GND AXLE
INTERFACE ACTUATOR
WIRING COM NO
CONNECTOR WIRE 105 SWITCHED
S SPEEDOMETER
TWO-SPEED AXLE ENABLE POWER
(FROM ECU) RELAY SHOWN
S-30 DE-ENERGIZED
WIRE 157
OPTIONAL SPEEDOMETER SIGNAL
SPEED SIGNAL (FROM ECU) ECU and Shift Selector are
REFER TO TEXT (SECTION C) available from Allison Transmission.
FOR REQUIRED CONNECTION Other items must be sourced separately. V09825.00.00

Figure 7–33. Two-Speed Axle Output

7–36 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

31. PARK BRAKE OUTPUT

USES: Turns on the park brake when the transmission is in neutral and output rpm is below a programmed speed.
Turns off the park brake when the transmission is shifted into a forward or reverse range.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: 1. Time delay to release brake after a range (other than neutral) is selected.
2. Output speed below park brake is enabled.

VOCATIONS: Various vehicular applications

PARK BRAKE
ENABLE FUNCTION MATRIX
WIRE 155 Park Brake ECU Park Brake Status of
V-11 Enable (Switch) Logic Output Signal Park Brake
PARK BRAKE
ENABLE OPEN OFF OFF ON
OPEN ON OFF ON
V CLOSED OFF OFF ON
WIRE 161
V-31 CLOSED ON ON OFF
SIGNAL RETURN

ECU
TO PARK BRAKE
SYSTEM
NC In relay state shown
(de-energized),
park brake is applied
S COM NO
WIRE 176
S-15 SWITCHED
PARK BRAKE OUTPUT POWER
NOTE: This function is controlled by inverse
CUSTOMER-FURNISHED logic. When the park brake signal is on,
RELAY the park brake is released. With no power
Relay shown de-energized applied, the park brake is applied.
V06656

Figure 7–34. Park Brake Output

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–37


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

31. NEUTRAL-TO-RANGE PARK BRAKE OUTPUT

USES: Turns on a NEUTRAL to range shift brake, after a programmed delay, when the transmission is in
NEUTRAL and output rpm is below a programmed speed. Turns off NEUTRAL to range shift brake,
after a programmed delay, when the transmission is shifted into a forward or reverse range.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: 1. Time delay to release brake after a range (other than neutral) is selected.
2. Output speed below park brake is enabled.

VOCATIONS: Various vehicular applications

TO BRAKE SYSTEM
IN RELAY STATE SHOWN
(DE-ENERGIZED),
TRANSMISSION IS IN FORWARD
V OR REVERSE RANGE

NC

ECU COM NO
WIRE 176 SWITCHED
S-15
NEUTRAL-TO-RANGE POWER
OPTIONAL SHIFT BRAKE RELAY IS SHOWN
VEHICLE INTERFACE DE-ENERGIZED
S WIRING CONNECTOR
Example Circuit Shown For For Spring-Apply Brake,
Brakes Which Require Energy Connect Brake Circuit
ECU is available from Allison Transmission. (hydraulic, Air, Electric) To N. C. Terminal
Other items must be sourced separately. To Apply Brake. V09877.00.00

Figure 7–35. Park Brake Output

7–38 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

31A. LOAD DUMP BRAKE OUTPUT (ALSO SHOWN: INPUT 52A, LOAD DUMP)

USES: Turns on the load dump brake when the transmission is in neutral and output rpm is below a programmed
speed. Turns off brake, after a programmed delay, when the transmission is shifted into a forward or
reverse range.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: 1. Time delay to release load dump brake after a range (other than neutral) is
selected.
2. Output speed below park brake is enabled.

VOCATIONS: Various vehicular applications

DASH
INDICATOR
LIGHT
CHECK SWITCHED
V TRANS 12V or 24V

NC
ECU
COM NO
WIRE 115
S-31 IGNITION

CUSTOMER-FURNISHED
S RELAY
Relay shown
de-energized

V06680

Figure 7–36. Park Brake Output

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–39


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

32. MANUAL MODE INDICATOR⎯ALSO REFER TO INPUT 55, MANUAL MODE)

USES: To turn on a dash light when transmission is operating in manual mode.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

SWITCHED
POWER
OPTIONAL VIM
NC
V
F2 WIRE 312
COM F3
NO
WIRE 112
V-22 D2
MANUAL MODE
ECU OPTIONAL MANUAL
VEHICLE MODE
INTERFACE RELAY (REQUIRED)
WIRING IS SHOWN DE-ENERGIZED
CONNECTOR Contacts close when transmission
S switches to manual mode.
Contacts open when transmission
switches to normal (automatic) mode.
ECU and VIM are available from Allison Transmission.
Other items must be sourced separately. V09878.00.00

Figure 7–37. Manual Mode Indicator

7–40 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

34. ALTERNATE SPEED / TORQUE CONTROL SELECT FOR GARAGE SHIFTS

USES: To control engine speed or torque during garage shifts.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: None

VOCATIONS: Various

TO ENGINE ECM:
ALTERNATE SPEED OR
TORQUE CONTROL INPUT

V N.C.

COM N.O.
WIRE 105 SWITCHED
V-19
ALTERNATE SPEED / TORQUE POWER
OPTIONAL CONTROL FOR GARAGE SHIFTS
ECU RELAY IS SHOWN
VEHICLE DE-ENERGIZED
INTERFACE
WIRING
CONNECTOR

ECU is available from Allison Transmission.


Other items must be sourced separately. V09879.00.00

Figure 7–38. Alternate Speed / Torque Control Select For Garage Shifts

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 7–41


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

WIRING SCHEMATICS—OPTIONAL INPUT/OUTPUT FUNCTIONS

These schematics show the intended use of the specified controls features which
have been validated in the configuration shown. Any miswiring or use of these
features which differs from that shown could result in damage to equipment or
WARNING! property, personal injury, or loss of life. ALLISON TRANSMISSION IS NOT
LIABLE FOR THE CONSEQUENCES ASSOCIATED WITH MISWIRING
OR UNINTENDED USE OF THESE FEATURES.

OUPUT FUNCTION

40. ENGINE SPEED / TORQUE CONTROL INDICATOR

USES: To indicate when engine speed / torque control is active.

VARIABLES TO SPECIFY: Ranges in which speed / torque control is activated.

VOCATIONS: Various

ENGINE SPEED/TORQUE CONTROL


INDICATOR

V WIRE 167 SWITCHED


V-5 POWER
ENGINE SPEED/TORQUE CONTROL
INDICATOR
OPTIONAL
VEHICLE
ECU INTERFACE
WIRING
CONNECTOR
If current in lamp circuit
exceeds 0.5 amp, ground
lamp through a relay.
S N.C.

ECU is available from N.O. COM


Allison Transmission. WIRE 167 SWITCHED
Other items must be POWER
sourced separately.
V09880.00.00

Figure 7–39. Engine Speed / Torque Control Indicator

7–42 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SECTION 8—CUSTOMER MODIFIABLE CONSTANTS (CMC)

Table 8–1 describes all CEC2 Controls parameters that can be modified in the field to suit specific needs of the end
user. Table 8–2 lists the standard values and optional values of the parameters. Only field personnel who have
attended the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool Training Class or Allison CEC2 Pro-Link® Reprogramming
Class are qualified to modify any of the CMCs.

Message: TRANSMISSION ECU DOES NOT SUPPORT REPROGRAM EEPROM—If this message
appears, the ECU is not capable of providing this information.

Message: NO CMCs FOUND—This message appears if the ECU does not support the reprogram EPROM
feature, but none of the enabled* Input/Output functions have CMCs associated with them.

Table 8–1. Description of Parameters


1. Transmission S/N 10 characters (alphanumeric)—“0”–“9” and uppercase “A”–“Z” only
2. Transmission Install Dates 6 digits—date format “mm-dd-yy”
3. Starting Range (Primary) Range the transmission will be in when starting out from zero output speed
while in Primary Mode. Starting range may be overridden by shift selector
position.
4. Starting Range (Secondary) Range the transmission will be in when starting out from zero output speed
while in Secondary Mode. Starting range may be overridden by shift
selector position.
5. Minimum Range (Primary) Lowest possible range that can be obtained while in Primary Mode.
6. Minimum Range (Secondary) Lowest possible range that can be obtained while in Secondary Mode.
7. Top Range Availability (Primary) Highest possible range that can be obtained while in Primary Mode
8. Top Range Availability (Primary) Highest possible range that can be obtained while in Secondary Mode.
9. Stall Check Range (Primary) Selected range for checking engine speed at converter stall while in Primary
Mode.
10. Stall Check Range (Secondary) Selected range for checking engine speed at converter stall while in
Secondary Mode
11. Retarder Option (Primary) Denotes which retarder option will be active while in Primary Mode.
12. Retarder Option (Secondary) Denotes which retarder option will be active while in Secondary Mode.
12a. Retarder Modifier (Primary) Denotes which retarder modifier will be active while in Primary Mode.
12b. Retarder Modifier (Secondary) Denotes which retarder modifier will be active while in Secondary Mode.
13. Available Reverses (Primary) Denotes which reverse option (R1 corresponds to low speed reverse, R2
corresponds to high speed reverse) will be active while in Primary Mode.
14. Available Reverses (Secondary) Denotes which reverse option (R1 corresponds to low speed reverse, R2
corresponds to high speed reverse) will be active while in Secondary Mode.
15. Neutral Tracking Denotes which neutral (N1 or N2) will be active. N1 corresponds to
splitter-low clutch. N2 corresponds to splitter-high clutch.
16. D1 Select Position (Primary) Denotes the range that will be held when the MODE button is pushed while
in the Primary Mode (pushbutton selectors only).
17. D1 Select Position (Secondary) Denotes the range that will be held when the MODE button is pushed while
in the Secondary Mode (pushbutton selectors only).
18. Max Output Speed Low Axle Select Denotes the maximum transmission output speed allowable for a shift to
low axle.

* I/O functions or specific wires must be enabled in calibration in order for the function or wire to work.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 8–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CUSTOMER MODIFIABLE CONSTANTS

Table 8–1. Description of Parameters (cont’d)


19. Bedhoist Interlock Enable Enables/disables the bedhoist interlock function. The enabled function
restricts reverse operation while lifting the dump bed.
20. Override Throttle Source Autodetect Shows if the throttle source has been overridden to accept a signal other
than what Autodetect has identified.
21. Range Selector 1st Range When the ECU commands 1st range, the range indicator output is active and
“YES” is selected.
22. Range Selector 2nd Range When the ECU commands 2nd range, the range indicator output is active and
“YES” is selected.
23. Range Selector 3rd Range When the ECU commands 3rd range, the range indicator output is active and
“YES” is selected.
24. Range Selector 4th Range When the ECU commands 4th range, the range indicator output is active and
“YES” is selected.
25. Range Selector 5th Range When the ECU commands 5th range, the range indicator output is active and
“YES” is selected.
26. Range Selector 6th Range When the ECU commands 6th range, the range indicator output is active and
“YES” is selected.
27. Range Indicator Neutral When the ECU commands Neutral range, the range indicator output is
active and “YES” is selected.
28. Range Indicator Reverse 1 When the ECU commands Reverse 1 range, the range indicator output is
active and “YES” is selected.
29. Range Indicator Reverse 2 When the ECU commands Reverse 2 range, the range indicator output is
active and “YES” is selected.
30. Speed to Turn “ON” Output Speed Speed at which the Output Speed Indicator A output becomes activated.
Indicator “A”
31. Speed to Turn “OFF” Output Speed Speed at which the Output Speed Indicator A output becomes de-activated.
Indicator “A”
32. Speed to Turn “ON” Output Speed Speed at which the Output Speed Indicator B output becomes activated.
Indicator “B”
33. Speed to Turn “OFF” Output Speed Speed at which the Output Speed Indicator B output becomes de-activated.
Indicator “B”
34. Turbine Speed to Turn “ON” Turbine speed at which the Engine Overspeed Indicator output becomes
Overspeed Indicator activated.
35. Turbine Speed to Turn “OFF” Turbine speed at which the Engine Overspeed Indicator output becomes de-
Overspeed Indicator activated.
36. Preselect Downshift Target Range with Denotes the limiting range in which preselect downshifts will occur when
Retarder (Primary) the retarder circuit is activated while in the Primary Mode.
37. Preselect Downshift Target Range with Denotes the limiting range in which preselect downshifts will occur when
Retarder (Secondary) the retarder circuit is activated while in the Secondary Mode.
38. Speed to Turn Park Brake Signal “ON” Denotes the allowable transmission output speed at which the parking brake
may be applied.

8–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CUSTOMER MODIFIABLE CONSTANTS (CMC)

Table 8–2. Standard Values/Optional Values


Operating Standard
Features Mode Value Optional Values
th
Primary 5 Range 3 , 4 , 5th Range
rd th
Stall Check Range
Secondary 5th Range 3rd, 4th, 5th Range
Primary Various 1, 3, 4, 5
Retarder Option
Secondary Various 1, 3, 4, 5
Primary Various None, A, B, AB
Retarder Modifier
Secondary Various None, A, B, AB
Primary R1 and R2 R1, R2, R1 and R2
Available Reverse
Secondary R1 and R2 R1, R2, R1 and R2
Neutral Tracking N1 N1, N2
Primary 6th Range All Forward Ranges
D1 Select
Secondary 6th Range All Forward Ranges
Max Output Speed Low Axle Select 40 rpm 40–1000 rpm
Bedhoist Interlock Enable Enabled Enabled, Disabled
Range Indicator—Reverse 2 Yes Yes, No
Range Indicator—Reverse 1 Yes Yes, No
Range Indicator—Neutral No Yes, No
st
Range Indicator—1 Range Yes Yes, No
Range Indicator—2nd Range Yes Yes, No
Range Indicator—3rd Range Yes Yes, No
th
Range Indicator—4 Range Yes Yes, No
th
Range Indicator—5 Range Yes Yes, No
Range Indicator—6th Range Yes Yes, No
Tubine Speed to turn Engine Overspeed ON 2350 rpm 2000–3000 rpm
Tubine Speed to turn Engine Overspeed OFF 2300 rpm 1950–2950 rpm
rd
Primary 3 Range 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th Range
Retarder Preselect Range
Secondary 3rd Range 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th Range
Override Throttle Source Autodetect Autodetect Autodetect, J1587, J1939, Analog
th
Primary 6 Range 4th, 5th, 6th Range
Top Range
Secondary 6th Range 4th, 5th, 6th Range
Primary 1st Range 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th Range
Minimum Range
Secondary 1st Range 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th Range
Primary 1st Range 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th Range
Starting Range
Secondary 1st Range 1st, 2nd, 3rd, 4th Range

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. 8–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

CUSTOMER MODIFIABLE CONSTANTS

Table 8–2. Standard Values/Optional Values (cont’d)


Operating Standard
Features Mode Value Optional Values
Speed to turn ON Output Speed Indicator A 60 rpm 60–4000 rpm
Speed to turn OFF Output Speed Indicator A 50 rpm 50–3990 rpm
Speed to turn ON Output Speed Indicator B 60 rpm 60–4000 rpm
Speed to turn OFF Output Speed Indicator B 50 rpm 50–3990 rpm
Park Brake Signal ON Speed 50 rpm 50–150 rpm
Transmission Serial Number 10 Characters—“0”–“9” and uppercase “A”–“Z” only
Transmission Installation Date 6 Digits—Date Format “mm-dd-yy”

8–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDICES

Appendix A Identification of Potential Circuit Problems

Appendix B Wire/Connector Chart

Appendix C Connector Part Numbers, Terminal Part Numbers,


Tool Part Numbers, and Repair Instructions

Appendix D Throttle Position Sensor Adjustment

Appendix E Welding on Vehicle/Vehicle Interface Module

Appendix F Hydraulic Schematics

Appendix G CEC2 System/ECU Wiring Schematics

Appendix H Externally-Generated Electronic Interference

Appendix J Diagnostic Data Reader Information

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. A–-1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDICES

NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX A—IDENTIFICATION OF POTENTIAL CIRCUIT PROBLEMS

Intermittent codes are a result of faults that are detected, logged, and then disappear, only to recur later. If, when
troubleshooting, a code is cleared in anticipation of it recurring and it does not, determine if items in the following
list are the source of the fault.

A. Circuit Inspection
1. Intermittent power/ground problems—can cause voltage problems during the ECU diagnostic pro-
cess which can set various codes depending upon where the ECU was in the diagnostic process.
2. Damaged terminals.
3. Dirty or corroded terminals.
4. Terminals not fully seated in the connector. Test indicated wires by uncoupling connector and gently
pulling on the wire at the rear of the connector and checking for excessive terminal movement.
5. Connectors not fully mated. Inspect for missing or damaged locktabs.
6. Screws or other sharp pointed objects pushed into or through one of the harnesses.
7. Harnesses which have rubbed through and may be allowing intermittent electrical contact between
two wires or between wires and vehicle frame members.
8. Broken wires within the braiding and insulation.

B. Finding an Intermittent Fault Condition


To find a fault, such as one of those listed, examine all connectors and the external wiring harnesses.
Harness routing may make it difficult to see or feel the complete harness. However, it is important to
thoroughly examine each harness for chafed or damaged areas. Road vibrations and bumps can damage a
poorly installed harness by moving it against sharp edges and cause some of the faults. If a visual
inspection does not identify a cause, move and wiggle the harness by hand until the fault is duplicated.

The next most probable cause of an intermittent code is an electronic part exposed to excessive vibration,
heat, or moisture. Examples of this are:

1. Exposed harness wires subjected to moisture.


2. A defective connector seal allowed moisture to enter the connector or part.
3. An electronic part (ECU, shift selector, solenoid, or throttle sensor) affected by vibration, heat, or
moisture may cause abnormal electrical conditions within the part.
When troubleshooting Item 3, eliminate all other possible causes before replacing any parts.

Another cause of intermittent codes is good parts in an abnormal environment. The abnormal environment
will usually include excessive heat, moisture, or voltage. For example, an ECU that receives excessive
voltage will generate a diagnostic code as it senses high voltage in a circuit. The code may not be repeated
consistently because different circuits may have this condition on each check. The last step in finding an
intermittent code is to observe if the code is set during sudden changes in the operating environment.

Troubleshooting an intermittent code requires looking for common conditions that are present whenever
the code is diagnosed.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. A–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX A—IDENTIFICATION OF POTENTIAL


DIAGNOSTIC CODES CIRCUIT PROBLEMS
C. Recurring Conditions
A recurring condition might be:

• Rain
• Outside temperature above or below a certain temperature
• Only on right-hand or left-hand turns
• When the vehicle hits a bump, etc.
If such a condition can be related to the code, it is easier to find the cause. If the time between code
occurrences is very short, troubleshooting is easier than if it is several weeks or more between code
occurrences.

A–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

The connector information in this appendix is provided for the convenience of the servicing technician. The
connector illustration and pin identifications for connection to Allison Transmission components will be accurate.
Allison Transmission components are:

• ECU
• Speed sensors
• Transmission connectors
• Shift selectors.
Other types of connectors for optional or customer-furnished components are provided based on typical past
practice for an Allison-designed system.

Contact St. Clair Technologies, Inc. or your vehicle manufacturer for information on connectors not found in this
appendix.

NOTE: The following abbreviation guide should be used to locate connector termination points for wires in
the CEC2 wiring harness(es).

Table B–1. Appendix B Abbreviation Guide


Termination Point Abbreviation Connector Name
AGND Analog Return (Ground)
ASOL Solenoid A—Main Valve Body Cover
BSOL Solenoid B—Main Valve Body Cover
CSOL Solenoid C—Main Valve Body Cover
DDRD Diagnostic Data Reader Connector—Deutsch
DDRP Diagnostic Data Reader Connector—Packard
DSOL Solenoid D—Main Valve Body Cover
ECU–S Electronic Control Unit—Selector (S) Connector
ECU–T Electronic Control Unit—Transmission (T) Connector
ECU–V Electronic Control Unit—Vehicle (V) Connector
ESOL Solenoid E—Main Valve Body Cover
FSOL Solenoid F—Main Valve Body Cover
GSOL Solenoid G—Main Valve Body Cover
H/JSOL Solenoid H/J— Trim Boost or 1–2 Cover
ISOL Solenoid I—1–2 Cover
J1939 J1939 Datalink From ECU Selector (S) Harness
KSOL Solenoid K—Lockup Cover
LOW Low or 1–2 Cover
LU Lockup Cover
MNVB Main Valve Body Cover
NE Input (Engine) Speed Sensor
NO Output Speed Sensor
NT Turbine Speed Sensor
PSS Primary Shift Selector

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

Table B–1. Appendix B Abbreviation Guide (cont’d)


Termination Point Abbreviation Connector Name
RNGTRM Chassis Ground Ring Terminal
SCI Serial Communication Interface
SSS Secondary Shift Selector
TB Trim Boost Cover
TEMP Sump Temperature Sensor—Lockup Cover
TPS Throttle Position Sensor
VIM Vehicle Interface Module
VIWS Vehicle Interface Wiring—ECU Selector (S) Harness
VIWV Vehicle Interface Wiring—ECU Vehicle (V) Harness

NOTE: Detail information related to each connector end view in this appendix was taken from the CEC2
System Wiring Schematic in Appendix G. Consult the wiring schematic for the relationship of each
connector to other system components.

B–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

COLOR CODE BLACK

16 1

32 17

V03368

Figure B–1. ECU Connector “S”

ECU CONNECTOR “S” (BLACK)


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
1 White 142-S1 Serial Communication Interface, High DDRP-J, DDRD-F, SCI-A
2 Tan 159-S2 Diagnostic Communication Link (ISO9141) VIWS-A
3 Pink 124-S3 Shift Selector Power PSS-N, SSS-N
4 Yellow 146-S4 Ignition Sense VIWS-E, DDRP-H, DDRD-E,
5 Orange 170-S5 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 1 PSS-A
6 Green 171-S6 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 2 PSS-B
7 Blue 172-S7 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 4 PSS-C
8 Yellow 173-S8 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 8 PSS-D
9 Tan 174-S9 Primary Shift Selector, Parity PSS-E
10 Green 175-S10 Shift Selector Mode Input PSS-M, SSS-M
11 Yellow 119-S11 General Purpose Input 4 VIWS-M
12 Green 182-S12 CAN Controller Shield (J1939) J1939C
13 Pink 183-S13 CAN Controller, High (J1939) J1939A
14 Blue 180-S14 Shift Selector Display PSS-S, SSS-S
15 Orange 176-S15 General Purpose Output 6 PSS-L, SSS-L, VIWS-L
16 Pink 136-S16 Battery Power PSS-R, SSS-R
17 Blue 151-S17 Serial Communication Interface, Low DDRP-K, DDRD-B, SCI-B
18 Tan 166-S18 General Purpose Output 7 VIWS-N
19
20
21 Orange 190-S21 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 1 SSS-A
22 Green 191-S22 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 2 SSS-B
23 Blue 192-S23 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 4 SSS-C
24 Yellow 193-S24 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 8 SSS-D
25 Tan 194-S25 Secondary Shift Selector, Parity SSS-E
26 Blue 169-S26 General Purpose Input 12 VIWS-S
27 Blue 163-S27 General Purpose Input 6 VIWS-R
28 Yellow 126-S28 General Purpose Input 9 VIWS-C
29 Gray 184-S29 CAN Controller, Low (J1939) J1939-B
30 Tan 157-S30 Vehicle Speed VIWS-D
31 Green 115-S31 Check Transmission VIWS-B
32 Gray 143-S32 Battery Return PSS-P, SSS-P, VIWS-P, DDRP-A,
DDRD-D

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–3
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

COLOR CODE BLUE

16 1

32 17

V03372

Figure B–2. ECU Connector “T”

ECU CONNECTOR “T” (BLUE)


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
1 Orange 102-T1 Solenoid Power, Solenoids F, G, and I(1) MNVB-J, MNVB-G, LOW-D(1)
2 Tan 121-T2 Solenoid Power, Solenoid K LU-A
3 Green 107-T3 Solenoid Power, Solenoid J(2) or H(2) TB-A(2) or LOW-A(2)
4 White 120-T4 F Solenoid, Low MNVB-F
5 Green 103-T5 B Solenoid, Low MNVB-D
6 Tan 129-T6 E Solenoid, Low MNVB-K
7 White 104-T7 A Solenoid, Low MNVB-B
8 Green 111-T8 I Solenoid, Low(1) LOW-C(1)
9 Pink 124-T9 TPS Power TPS-C
10 Blue 156-T10 Throttle Position Sensor Input TPS-B
11
12
13 Yellow 195-T13 Transmission Identification MNVB-R
14 Tan 141-T14 Engine Speed Sensor, High NE-A
15 Orange 149-T15 Turbine Speed Sensor, High NT-A
16 Yellow 139-T16 Output Speed Sensor, High NO-A
17 Yellow 130-T17 Solenoid Power, Solenoids A and B MNVB-A, MNVB-C
18
19 Yellow 116-T19 Solenoid Power, Solenoids E, D, and C MNVB-L, MNVB-N, MNVB-E
20 Orange 128-T20 K Solenoid, Low LU-B
21 Blue 131-T21 G Solenoid, Low MNVB-H
22 White 110-T22 J or H Solenoid, Low(2) TB-B or LOW-B(2)
23 White 127-T23 D Solenoid, Low MNVB-M
24 Blue 101-T24 C Solenoid, Low MNVB-P
25 Green 135-T25 Analog Return TPS-A, LU-C
26
27 Tan 147-T27 Sump Temperature Sensor Input LU-D
28
29
30 Orange 150-T30 Engine Speed Sensor, Low NE-B
31 Blue 140-T31 Turbine Speed Sensor, Low NT-B
32 Green 148-T32 Output Speed Sensor, Low NO-B
(1)
I Solenoid only present on DP 8610 and S 9810M models in the low shift body.
(2)
J Solenoid is present on 5610, 6610, and M 9610 models in the trim boost body. H Solenoid is only present on
8610 and S 9810M models in the low shift body.

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

COLOR CODE GRAY

16 1

32 17

V03373

Figure B–3. ECU Connector “V”

ECU CONNECTOR “V” (GRAY)


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
1 Pink 136-V1 Battery Power VIM-E1
2 White 114-V2 General Purpose Output 1 VIM-F3
3 Orange 132-V3 General Purpose Output 2 VIM-B1
4 White 113-V4 Reverse Warning VIM-F2
5 White 167-V5 General Purpose Output 8 VIWV-V
6 Tan 123-V6 Neutral Start VIM-D1
7
8 Pink 124-V8 Sensor Power TPS-C (Optional)
9 Blue 179-V9 Engine Water Temperature VIWV-M
10 Blue 156-V10 Throttle Position Sensor TPS-B (Optional)
11 Green 155-V11 General Purpose Input 1 VIWV-A
12 Yellow 153-V12 General Purpose Input 2 VIWV-B
13 Blue 118-V13 General Purpose Input 3 VIWV-C
14 Tan 177-V14 General Purpose Input 10 VIWV-S
15
16 Pink 136-V16 Battery Power VIM-E2
17 Gray 143-V17 Battery Return VIM-A1
18 White 125-V18 General Purpose Output 4 VIM-C2
19 Green 105-V19 General Purpose Output 5 VIWV-E
20 Tan 157-V20 Vehicle Speed VIM-B2
21
22 Tan 112-V22 General Purpose Output 3 VIM-D2
23
24 Green 135-V24 Analog Return TPS-A (Optional), VIWV-N
25
26 Yellow 146-V26 Ignition Sense VIM-F1
27 White 154-V27 General Purpose Input 5 VIWV-D
28 Orange 178-V28 General Purpose Input 11 VIWV-R
29 Orange 137-V29 General Purpose Input 7 VIWV-U
30 Green 117-V30 General Purpose Input 8 VIWV-P
31 Yellow 161-V31 Digital Return (GPI) VIWV-L
32 Gray 143-V32 Battery Return VIM-A2

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–5
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

RECEPTACLE B A A B
PLUG
(PIN) G F E D C C D E F G (SOCKET)
N M L K J H H J K L M N
W V U T S R P P R S T U V W

c b a Z Y X X Y Z a b c
h g f e d d e f g h

k j j k
m l l m

V06602

Figure B–4. ITT Cannon Bulkhead Connector

BULKHEAD CONNECTOR FOR “T” HARNESS (Receptacle With Sockets, Plug With Pins)
Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Yellow 130-T17 Solenoid Power, Solenoids A and B ECU-T17, MNVB-A, MNVB-C
B White 104-T7 A Solenoid, Low ECU-T7, MNVB-B
C Green 107-T3 Solenoid Power, Solenoid J or H ECU-T3, TB-A or LOW-A
D White 110-T22 J or H Solenoid, Low ECU-T22, TB-B or LOW-B
E Tan 121-T2 Solenoid Power, Solenoid K ECU-T2, LU-A
F White 120-T4 F Solenoid, Low ECU-T4, MNVB-F
G
H Blue 131-T21 G Solenoid, Low ECU-T21, MNVB-H
I Yellow 116-T19 Solenoid Power, Solenoids E, D, and C ECU-T19, MNVB-L, MNVB-N, MNVB-E
J Orange 102-T1 Solenoid Power, Solenoids F, G, and I ECU-T1, MNVB-J, MNVB-G, LOW-D
K Green 103-T5 B Solenoid, Low ECU-T5, MNVB-D
L
M Orange 128-T20 K Solenoid, Low ECU-T20, LU-B
N
P Tan 129-T6 E Solenoid, Low ECU-T6, MNVB-K
R Yellow 195-T13 Transmission Identification ECU-T13, MNVB-R
S
T Pink 124-T9 TPS Power ECU-T9, TPS-C
U
V
W Blue 156-T10 Throttle Position Sensor Input ECU-T10, TPS-B
X Green 111-T8 I Solenoid, Low ECU-T8, LOW-C
Y
Z
a Tan 141-T14 Engine Speed Sensor, High ECU-T14, NE-A
b Orange 149-T15 Turbine Speed Sensor, High ECU-T15, NT-A
c Yellow 139-T16 Output Speed Sensor, High ECU-T16, NO-A
d Tan 147-T27 Sump Temperature Sensor Input ECU-T27, LU-D
e Orange 150-T30 Engine Speed Sensor, Low ECU-T30, NE-B
f Blue 101-T24 C Solenoid, Low ECU-T24, MNVB-P
g Green 135-T25 Analog Return ECU-T25, TPS-A, LU-C

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

BULKHEAD CONNECTOR FOR “T” HARNESS (Receptacle With Sockets, Plug With Pins) (cont’d)
Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
h Blue 140-T31 Turbine Speed Sensor, Low ECU-T31, NT-B
j
k Green 148-T32 Output Speed Sensor, Low ECU-T32, NO-B
l
m White 127-T23 D Solenoid, Low ECU-T23, MNVB-M

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–7
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

RECEPTACLE PLUG
(PIN) L A A L (SOCKET)
K B B K
M M
J S N C C N S J
R P P R
H D D H

G E E G
F F

V06603

Figure B–5. Main Valve Body Cover Connector

CANNON 16-WAY MAIN VALVE BODY COVER CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Yellow 130-T17 Solenoid Power, Solenoids A and B ECU-T17, MNVB-C
B White 104-T7 A Solenoid, Low ECU-T7
C Yellow 130-T17 Solenoid Power, Solenoids A and B ECU-T17, MNVB-A
D Green 103-T5 B Solenoid, Low ECU-T5
E Yellow 116-T19 Solenoid Power, Solenoids E, D, and C ECU-T19, MNVB-L, MNVB-N
F White 120-T4 F Solenoid, Low ECU-T4
G Orange 102-T1 Solenoid Power, Solenoids F, G, and I ECU-T1, MNVB-J, LOW-D
H Blue 131-T21 G Solenoid, Low ECU-T21
J Orange 102-T1 Solenoid Power, Solenoids F, G, and I ECU-T1, MNVB-G, LOW-D
K Tan 129-T6 E Solenoid, Low ECU-T6
L Yellow 116-T19 Solenoid Power, Solenoids E, D, and C ECU-T19, MNVB-N, MNVB-E
M White 127-T23 D Solenoid, Low ECU-T23
N Yellow 116-T19 Solenoid Power, Solenoids E, D, and C ECU-T19, MNVB-L, MNVB-E
P Blue 101-T24 C Solenoid, Low ECU-T24
R Yellow 195-T13 Transmission Identification ECU-T13
S Future Use

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

RECEPTACLE PLUG
(PIN) (SOCKET)

A D
D A

B C
C B

V06604

Figure B–6. Lockup Valve Body Cover Connector

CANNON 4-WAY LOCKUP VALVE BODY COVER CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Points*
A Tan 121-T2 Solenoid Power, Solenoid K ECU-T2
B Orange 128-T20 K Solenoid, Low ECU-T20
C Green 135-T25 Analog Return ECU-T25, TPS-A
D Tan 147-T27 Sump Temperature Sensor Input ECU-T27

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–9
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

RECEPTACLE PLUG
(PIN) (SOCKET)
A
A
E B
B E

D C
C D

V06605

Figure B–7. Trim Boost or Low Valve Body Cover Connector

CANNON 5-WAY TRIM BOOST BODY COVER CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Points*
(1)
A Green 107-T3 Solenoid Power, Solenoid J ECU-T3
B White 110-T22 J Solenoid, Low ECU-T22
C Not Used
D Not Used
E Not Used
(1)
J solenoid is used on all 5610, 6610, and 9610 models.

CANNON 5-WAY LOW BODY COVER CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Points*
A Green 107-T3 Solenoid Power, Solenoid H(1) ECU-T3
B White 110-T22 H Solenoid, Low ECU-T22
C Green 111-T8 I Solenoid, Low(2) ECU-T8
D Orange 102-T1 Solenoid Power, Solenoids F, G, and I ECU-T1, MNVB-G, MNVB-J
E NOT USED
(1)
H solenoid is used on all 8610 and 9810 models.
(2)
I solenoid is used for lock-in-range on the 8610 and 9810 models.

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

S K
W D

COLOR CODE GREEN

HARNESS DEVICE

T A
L E
NOTE: Letters I, O, and Q not used V03369

Figure B–8. Remote Selector Connector

REMOTE SHIFT SELECTOR CONNECTOR—PRIMARY SELECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Orange 170-S5 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 1 ECU-S5
B Green 171-S6 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 2 ECU-S6
C Blue 172-S7 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 4 ECU-S7
D Yellow 173-S8 Primary Shift Selector, Data Bit 8 ECU-S8
E Tan 174-S9 Primary Shift Selector, Parity ECU-S9
F
G
H
J
K
L Orange 176-S15 General Purpose Output 6 or 31 VIWS-L, SSS-L, ECU-S15
M Green 175-S10 Shift Selector Mode Input SSS-M, ECU-S10
N Pink 124-S3 Sensor Power SSS-N, ECU-S3
P Gray 143-S32 Signal Return VIWS-P, SSS-P, DDRP-A, DDRD-E,
ECU-S32
R Pink 136-S16 Battery Power SSS-R, ECU-S16
S Blue 180-S14 Shift Selector Display SSS-S, ECU-S14
T Blue 186 Chassis Return (12V) or Output From 12V SSS-T, VIWS-T
Dimmer (24V)
U Red 187 Selector Backlighting/Feed (12V) or Not SSS-U, VIWS-U
Used (24V)
V White 188 Selector Backlighting/Return (12V and 24V) SSS-V, VIWS-V
W

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–11
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

REMOTE SHIFT SELECTOR CONNECTOR—SECONDARY SELECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Orange 190-S21 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 1 ECU-S21
B Green 191-S22 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 2 ECU-S22
C Blue 192-S23 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 4 ECU-S23
D Yellow 193-S24 Secondary Shift Selector, Data Bit 8 ECU-S24
E Tan 194-S25 Secondary Shift Selector, Parity ECU-S25
F
G
H
J
K
L Orange 176-S15 General Purpose Output 6 or 31 VIWS-L, PSS-L, ECU-S15
M Green 175-S10 Shift Selector Mode Input PSS-M, ECU-S10
N Pink 124-S3 Sensor Power PSS-N, ECU-S3
P Gray 143-S32 Signal Return VIWS-P, PSS-P, DDRP-A, DDRD-E,
ECU-S32
R Pink 136-S16 Battery Power PSS-R, ECU-S16
S Blue 180-S14 Shift Selector Display PSS-S, ECU-S14
T Blue 186 Chassis Return (12V) or Output From 12V PSS-T, VIWS-T
Dimmer (24V)
U Red 187 Selector Backlighting/Feed (12V) or Not PSS-U, VIWS-U
Used (24V)
V White 188 Selector Backlighting/Return (12V and 24V) PSS-V, VIWS-V
W

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–12 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

A B

SPEED SENSOR
V06606

Figure B–9. Speed Sensor Connector

INPUT (ENGINE) SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Tan 141-T14 Input (Engine) Speed Sensor Hi ECU-T14
B Orange 150-T30 Input (Engine) Speed Sensor Lo ECU-T30

TURBINE SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Orange 149-T15 Turbine Speed Sensor Hi ECU-T15
B Blue 140-T31 Turbine Speed Sensor Lo ECU-T31

OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Yellow 139-T16 Output Speed Sensor Hi ECU-T16
B Green 148-T32 Output Speed Sensor Lo ECU-T32

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–13
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

G F

H E

J D

K C

L B

M A

V00644.01

Figure B–10. Diagnostic Tool Connector (Packard)

DIAGNOSTIC CONNECTOR
Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Gray 143-S32 Signal Return ECU-S32, VIWS-P, PSS-P, SSS-P
B
C
D
E
F
G
H Yellow 146-S4 Ignition Sense ECU-S4, VIWS-E
J White 142-S1 Serial Communication (+) ECU-S1, SCI-A
K Blue 151-S17 Serial Communication (–) ECU-S17, SCI-B
L
M

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–14 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

F B

A
E C
D

6-PIN
V04851.02.00

Figure B–11. Optional Deutsch Diagnostic Tool Connector or Optional DDU Connector

OPTIONAL 6-PIN DIAGNOSTIC CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A White 142-S1 Serial Communication (+) ECU-S1, SCI-A
B Blue 151-S17 Serial Communication (–) ECU-S17, SCI-B
C Yellow 146-S4 Ignition Sense ECU-S4, VIWS-E
D
E Gray 143-S32 Signal Return ECU-S32, VIWS-P, PSS-P, SSS-P
F

6-PIN CONNECTOR FOR OPTIONAL DDU (AT DDU)


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A
B Blue 151-S17 Serial Communication (–) ECU-S17, SCI-B
C
D Gray 143-S32 Signal Return ECU-S32, VIWS-P, PSS-P, SSS-P
E Yellow 146-S4 Ignition Sense ECU-S4, VIWS-E
F White 142-S1 Serial Communication (+) ECU-S1, SCI-A

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–15
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

S
R K
P
W D
COLOR CODE BLUE COLOR CODE WHITE

HARNESS CONNECTOR
T A

L E
VIW—V VIW—S
V03371

Figure B–12. VIW Connector (Packard Micro-Pack)

VIW–V CONNECTOR
Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Green 155-V11 General Purpose Input 14, 52, or 52A ECU-V11
B Yellow 153-V12 General Purpose Input 5 ECU-V12
C Blue 118-V13 General Purpose Input 11 or 16 ECU-V13
D White 154-V27 General Purpose Input 29 or 29A ECU-V27
E Green 105-V19 General Purpose Output 18 ECU-V19
F
G
H
J
K
L Yellow 161-V31 Signal Return (GPI) ECU-V31
M Blue 179-V9 Engine Water Temperature (Ref) ECU-V9
N Green 135-V24 Analog Return ECU-V24, TPS-A
P Green 117-V30 General Purpose Input 53 ECU-V30
R Orange 178-V28 General Purpose Input 25 or 34 ECU-V28
S Tan 177-V14 General Purpose Input 51 ECU-V14
T
U Orange 137-V29 General Purpose Input 17 ECU-V29U
V White 167-V5 General Purpose Output 5 ECU-V5
W

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–16 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

VIW–S CONNECTOR
Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s) *
A Tan 159-S2 Diagnostic Communication Link (ISO 9141) ECU-S2
B Green 115-S31 Check Transmission ECU-S31
C Yellow 126-S28 General Purpose Input 1 or 9 ECU-S28
D Tan 157-S30 Vehicle Speed ECU-S30
E Yellow 146-S4 Ignition Sense ECU-S4, DDRP-H, DDRD-C
F
G
H
J
K
L Orange 176-S15 General Purpose Output 6 or 31 ECU-S15, PSS-L, SSS-L
M Yellow 119-S11 General Purpose Input 50 ECU-S11
N Tan 166-S18 General Purpose Output 16 ECU-S18
P Gray 143-S32 Signal Return ECU-S32, PSS-P, SSS-P, DDRP-A,
DDRD-E
R Blue 163-S27 General Purpose Input 8 ECU-S27
S Blue 169-S26 General Purpose Input 54 ECU-S26
T Blue 186 Chassis Return (12V) or Output From 12V PSS-T, SSS-T
Dimmer (24V)
U Red 187 Selector Backlighting/Feed (12V) or Not PSS-U, SSS-U
Used (24V)
V White 188 Selector Backlighting/Return (12V and 24V) PSS-V, SSS-V
W

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–17
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

A B C

V00645

Figure B–13. TPS Connector

THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A Green 135-T25 or Analog Return ECU-T25 or V24, LU-C, VIWV-N
135-V24
B Blue 156-T10 or V10 TPS Sensor Input ECU-T10 or V10
C Pink 124-T9 or V8 TPS Power ECU-T9 or V8

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–18 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

A1 A3

F1 F3
V01100

Figure B–14. VIM Connector (Harness)

VIM CONNECTOR (HARNESS)


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A1 Gray 143-V17 Battery (–) ECU-V17
A2 Gray 143-V32 Battery (–) ECU-V32
A3 Reserved
B1 Orange 132-V3 GPO 1 ECU-V3
B2 Tan 157-V20 Vehicle Speed ECU-V20
B3 Reserved
C1 Reserved
C2 White 125-V18 GPO 9 ECU-V18
C3 Reserved
D1 Tan 123-V6 Neutral Start (+) ECU-V6
D2 Tan 112-V22 GPO 7 or 32 ECU-V22
D3 Reserved
E1 Pink 136-V1 Battery (+) ECU-V1
E2 Pink 136-V16 Battery (+) ECU-V16
E3 Reserved
F1 Yellow 146-V26 Ignition Sense ECU-V26
F2 White 113-V4 Reverse Warning ECU-V4
F3 White 114-V2 GPO 4 ECU-V2

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–19
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

A1

K3
V01240

Figure B–15. VIM Connector (Harness)

VIM CONNECTOR (HARNESS 30-WAY)


Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*
A1 313NO Reverse Warning Relay—Normally Open
A2 314CM Output Wire 114 Relay—Common
A3 314NO Output Wire 114 Relay—Normally Open
B1 313CM Reverse Warning Relay—Common
B2 314NC Output Wire 114 Relay—Normally Closed
B3 Reserved
C1 346 Ignition Power
C2 312NC Output Wire 112 Relay—Normally Closed
C3 Reserved
D1 325NC Output Wire 125 Relay—Normally Closed
D2 332NC Output Wire 132 Relay—Normally Closed
D3 Reserved
E1 325CM Output Wire 125 Relay—Common
E2 332CM Output Wire 132 Relay—Common
E3 332NO Output Wire 132 Relay—Normally Open
F1 323NO Neutral Start Relay—Normally Open
F2 312CM Output Wire 112 Relay—Common
F3 312NO Output Wire 112 Relay—Normally Open
G1 323CM Neutral Start Relay—Common
G2 Reserved
G3 Reserved
H1 Reserved
H2 357UF Optional Speed Signal
H3 Reserved
J1 Battery Power
J2 Battery Power
J3 Reserved
K1 Battery Return
K2 Battery Return
K3 Reserved
* Termination Points are determined by OEM electrical system design.

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
B–20 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

V00570.01

Figure B–16. SCI Interface Connector

SCI INTERFACE CONNECTOR

Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*


A White 142-S1 Serial Communication Interface, Hi ECU-S1, DDRP-J, DDRD-A,
DDU-A
B Blue 151-S17 Serial Communication Interface, Lo ECU-S17, DDRP-K, DDRD-B,
DDU-B

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.
Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. B–21
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX B—WIRE/CONNECTOR CHART

A or H

B or L C or S

V03384

Figure B–17. J1939 Interface Connector

J1939 INTERFACE CONNECTOR

Terminal No.* Color Wire No. Description Termination Point(s)*


A or H Red 183-S13 J1939 Controller, Hi ECU-S13
B or L Gray 184-S29 J1939 Controller, Lo ECU-S29
C or S Green 182-S12 J1939 Shield ECU-S12

* For clarification of terminal number and termination point(s), refer to ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC in Appendix G.

B–22 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

Contents Page
List of Special Tools Required To Service CEC2 Wiring Harnesses . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–2
C–1. Delphi-Packard Micro-Pack 100W Connectors (ECU, VIWV, VIWS,
Shift Selectors). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–5
C–2. Delphi-Packard Metri-Pack 150 Series Connectors—Pull-to-Seat (Speed Sensor,
30-Way and 18-Way VIM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–9
C–3. Delphi-Packard Metri-Pack 150 Series Connectors—Push-to-Seat
(Sump Temperature Thermistor) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–13
C–4. Delphi-Packard Metri-Pack 280 Series Connectors—Push-to-Seat (DDR and SCI) . . C–15
C–5. Delphi-Packard WeatherPack Connectors (TPS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–19
C–6. Deutsch Connectors (6-Way Optional Diagnostic Tool or Optional DDU) . . . . . . . . . C–23
C–7. ITT Cannon Connector—Crimped (35-Way “T” Harness Bulkhead) . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–25
C–8. ITT Cannon Connectors—Soldered (Main Valve Body Internal Harness, Main Valve
Body Harness, Lockup Body Harness, Trim Boost or Low Body Harness) . . . . . . . . . C–29
C–9. Deutsch DT Series Connectors (3-Way J1939 Connector) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–33
C–10. Repair of a Broken Wire with In-Line Butt Splice . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–35
List of CEC2 Connector Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . C–37

NOTE: Allison Transmission provides service of wiring harnesses and wiring harness components as follows:
• Repair parts for the internal wiring harness and for wiring harness components attached to the shift
selector will be available through the Allison Transmission Parts Distribution Center (PDC). Use
the P/N from your appropriate parts catalog or from Appendix C in this manual. Allison
Transmission is responsible for warranty on these parts.

• Repair parts for the external harnesses and external harness components must be obtained from
St. Clair Technologies Inc. (SCTI). SCTI provides parts to any Allison customer or OEM and is
responsible for warranty on these parts. SCTI recognizes AT, manufacturers, and SCTI part
numbers. SCTI provides a technical HELPLINE at 519-627-1673 (Wallaceburg). SCTI will have
parts catalogs available. The SCTI addresses and phone numbers for parts outlets are:

St. Clair Technologies, Inc. St. Clair Technologies, Inc.


920 Old Glass Road Calle Damanti S/N Col
Wallaceburg, Ontario N8A 4L8 Guadalupe–Guaymas
Phone: (519) 627-1673 Sonora, Mexico 85440
Fax: (519) 627-4227 Phone: 011-526-2222-43834
Fax: 011-526-2222-43553

• St. Clair Technologies, Inc. stocks an external harness repair kit as a source for some external
harness repair parts. SCTI is the source for external harness repair parts.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
List Of Special Tools Required To Service CEC2 Wiring Harnesses
Tool Number Tool Type Paragraph Reference
23046604 Splice, Sealed (14–16 AWG) 1–10
23046605 Splice, Sealed (18–22 AWG) 1–10
J 25070 Heat Gun 1–10
J 34182 Crimper 1–6, 1–7, 1–9
J 35123 Crimper (Alternate) 1–2
J 35606 Crimper (Alternate) 1–5
J 35615 Wire Stripper 1–10
J 35689-A Remover 1–2, 1–3
J 38125-10 Remover 1–5
J 38125-13 Remover 1–4
J 38125-6 Crimper 1–4, 1–5
J 38125-7 Crimper 1–2, 1–4
J 38125-8 Crimper 1–10
J 38582-3 Remover 1–6
J 38852 Crimper (Alternate) 1–5
J 39227 Remover 1–1
J 41193 Connector Repair Kit (FMTV) 1–7
J 41193-1 Guide Pin 1–7
J 41193-2 Insertion Tool 1–7
J 41193-3 Terminal Remover 1–7
J 42215 Crimper 1–1, 1–3
None 50–70 Percent Tin Resin Core Solder 1–8
None Pen-Type Soldering Iron (Max OD = 0.125 inch) 1–8
None Desoldering Braid 1–8

C–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
RETAINER (Keyed to fit proper ECU socket; color-coded to match Strain Relief)

SOCKET TERMINAL (FEMALE)

CONNECTOR

TYPICAL WIRE

SEAL

LOCKTAB (SECURES
RETAINER)

TERMINAL LOCKING
FINGER
LOCKING POST

STRAIN RELIEF (Color-code


should match Retainer)

LOCKTABS

CAVITY PLUG

Lock terminal
here
SOCKET TERMINAL

WIRE

J 42215 CRIMPING TOOL


V03419.01

Figure C–1A. Delphi-Packard Micro-Pack Connector (ECU)

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

SECONDARY LOCK

MATING CONNECTOR
WITH FEMALE (SOCKET)
TERMINALS

J 39227
REMOVAL
TOOL

LOCKTAB
(RETAINS LOCK ASSIST)

WIRE SEAL
LOCK ASSIST

VIEW A

LOCKING
FINGERS WIRE

MATING CONNECTOR
WITH MALE (PIN)
TERMINALS
WIRE SEAL
VIEW A

CAVITY PLUG

CONDUIT CLIP

SOCKET
TERMINAL

Lock terminal here


PIN TERMINAL

WIRE

J 42215 CRIMPING TOOL V03421

Figure C–1B. Delphi-Packard Micro-Pack Connector (VIWV, VIWS, Shift Selector)

C–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–1. DELPHI-PACKARD MICRO-PACK 100W CONNECTORS
(ECU, VIWV, VIWS, SHIFT SELECTORS)
A. Connector/Terminal Repairs
Crimping Tool J 42215
Remover Tool J 39227
Use Description Manufacturers P/N
Electronic Control Unit (Harness) Strain Relief, 32-Way Black 12191001 *
Seal, 32-Way 15305333 *
Cavity Plug 12129557 *+
Connector 15305371 *
Retainer, Black 12129021 *
Terminal, Socket 12084912 *
CPA (Connector Position Assurance) 12177289 *
Strain Relief, 32-Way Gray 12191002 *
Retainer, Gray 12129022 *
Strain Relief, 32-Way Blue 12191003 *
Retainer, Blue 12129023 *
VIWV and VIWS (Harness) Connector, Gray 12160542 +
Wire Seal, Green 12110693 +
VIWV Only Lock Assist, Blue 12191177
Terminal, Pin 12160551 +
Cavity Plug 12129557 *
Conduit Clip, Black 12176394 *+
VIWS Only Lock Assist, White 12191178
Shift Selector (Harness) Connector, Gray 12160280 *
Wire Seal, Gray 15304882 *
Secondary Lock, Green 12160494 *
Terminal, Socket 12084912 *
Shift Selector (Device) Connector, Gray 12160542 +
Wire Seal, Green 12110693 +
Lock Assist/Seal, Green 12191176 +
Conduit Clip, Black 12176394 *+
VIWV and VIWS (Device) Connector, Gray 12160280 *
Wire Seal, Gray 15304882 *
VIWV Only Secondary Lock, Blue 12191172
Terminal, Socket 12084912 *
VIWS Only Secondary Lock, White 12191173

* These parts are contained in Allison Kit P/N 29532362.


+ These parts are contained in Allison Kit P/N 29530475.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
B. Terminal Removal
1. ECU Harness Connectors (Figure C–1A)

The color-code of the strain relief should match the color-code of the retainer. However, cases
have been reported where this has not occurred. The retainer color-code and key configuration
makes sure that the proper wiring harness connector is in the right socket of the ECU. The
CAUTION: color-code of the strain relief is of secondary importance and may not agree with the retainer.
Change the strain relief to match the color-code of the retainer (Figure C–1A) when color-code
mismatch is found.

a. Use a small-bladed screwdriver to gently release the locktabs at the splitline of the strain relief.
b. Spread the strain relief open.
c. Remove the retainer from the connector by using a small-bladed screwdriver to depress the
locktabs on the side of the connector.
d. Remove a selected terminal by pushing forward on the wire or by lifting the locking finger and
pulling the wire and terminal rearward out of the connector.

2. VIWV and VIWS Harness Connectors and Shift Selector (Device) Connectors (Figure C–1B)
a. Lift locktab on the side of the connector and remove the lock assist.
b. Open the conduit clip on the back of the connector after lifting locktabs on each side and sliding
clip back to release it from connector.
c. Use the J 39227 tool to release the locking finger inside the connector and pull the terminal/wire
out the rear of the connector.

3. VIWV and VIWS (Device) Connectors and Shift Selector Harness Connectors (Figure C–1B)
a. Carefully insert a small screwdriver blade between the connector body and the secondary lock.
Twist/pry to remove the secondary lock from the connector body.
b. Open the conduit clip on the back of the connector after lifting locktabs on each side and sliding
clip back to release it from connector.
c. Use the J 39227 tool to release the locking finger inside the connector and pull the terminal/wire
out the rear of the connector.

C. Terminal Crimping
1. Carefully strip insulation to leave 0.20 ± 0.02 inch (5.0 mm ± 0.5 mm) of bare wire showing.

2. Insert the new terminal to be crimped in the J 42215 crimping tool. There is a spring-loaded
terminal positioner at the front of the tool to hold the terminal in place. Squeeze the crimper
handles for a few clicks to start the crimping process but leave room to insert the wire end.

3. Insert the bare wire end into the terminal. Squeeze the crimper handles to complete the crimping
process and until the crimper handles open when released to remove the terminal/wire from the
tool.

C–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C. Terminal Crimping (cont’d)

4. Complete terminal installation for VIW and Shift Selector Connectors as follows: (Figure C–1B)
a. Insert the wire seal in the back of the connector.
b. Push the terminal/wire assembly through the proper hole in the back of the wire seal. Push the
wire in until the terminal clicks into position. Gently pull rearward on the wire to be sure the
terminal is fully seated. Install cavity plugs as needed.
c. Install the lock assist or secondary lock into the connector body.
d. Close the conduit clip around the conduit and lock the clip into the rear of the connector body.
5. Complete terminal installation of the ECU Connectors as follows: (Figure C–1A)
a. Align the locking posts on the connector with the seal and push the locking posts through the
seal into the mating holes in the strain relief (if the connector was removed from the strain
relief).
b. Push the terminal/wire assembly through the proper hole in the back of the seal. Push the wire
in until the terminal clicks into position.

NOTE: All terminals must be properly positioned to install the retainer in Step (5c).

c. Install the retainer on the connector body to lock the terminals in position. Pull rearward on the
wire to be sure the terminal is fully seated. Install cavity plugs as needed.
d. Position the conduit inside the strain relief and snap the strain relief halves together.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–7


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

STRAIN RELIEF

SEALING PLUG SPECIAL Seal plug


BOLT butts up here

RETAINER 12 WAY J 35689-A


SEAL PLUG
Remove in HARNESS
this direction
CONNECTOR

Seat in
WIRE AND this direction
TERMINAL
Insertion of removal tool (J 35689-A) forces
lock tang toward body of terminal

VIEW A
Butt wire against terminal holder

Use wire gauge 18-16 slot

WIRE SIDE
18-16
22-20
E
C
A

J 38125-7
D

TERMINAL
B

VIEW B
Push lock to insert
terminal end

J 35123
WIRE SIDE

TERMINAL HOLDER
18-16
22-20

VIEW C V01685

Figure C–2. Delphi-Packard Metri-Pack 150 Series Connectors—Pull-to-Seat


(Speed Sensor, 30-Way and 18-Way VIM)

C–8 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–2. DELPHI-PACKARD METRI-PACK 150 SERIES CONNECTORS—PULL-TO-SEAT
(SPEED SENSOR, 30-WAY AND 18-WAY VIM)

A. Connector/Terminal Repairs

Crimping Tool J 38125-7


Wire Crimp Anvil “E”
Insulation Crimp Anvil “C”
Alternate Crimping Tool J 35123
Remover Tool J 35689-A
Use Description Manufacturers P/N
Input Speed Connector 12162193
(Ni) Sensor Terminal 12103881
Turbine Speed Connector 12162193
(Nt) Sensor Terminal 12103881
Output Speed Connector 12162193
(No) Sensor Terminal 12103881
Vehicle Interface Connector (VIM)
Module (VIM) Connector Body 12040920
9-Way Seal (x2) 12040936
18-Way Strain Relief 12110545
Special Bolt 12129426
Bolt Retainer 12034236
Cavity Plug 12034413
Terminal 12103881
Vehicle Interface Connector (OEM)
Module (Vehicle) Connector Body 12034397
15-Way Seal (x2) 12040879
30-Way Strain Relief 12110546
Special Bolt 12129426
Bolt Retainer 12034236
Cavity Plug 12034413
Terminal 12103881

B. Terminal Removal

NOTE: Do not solder crimps.

1. Insert needle end of terminal remover J 35689-A into the small notch between the connector and
the terminal to be removed (Figure C–2, View A). Push the lock tang toward the terminal.
2. Push the wire and terminal out of the connector (this is a “pull-to-seat” terminal).
3. Pull terminal as far as necessary from the connector. This will be limited by the number of other
wires inserted into the connector and by the distance between the back side of the connector and
the beginning of the harness covering.
4. If terminal is to be replaced, cut the terminal between the core and insulation crimp to minimize
wire loss.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–9


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C. Terminal Crimping—VIM And Speed Sensor Terminals (Standard Crimping Tool)
1. If a spare wire is used, the wire should be pushed through the proper hole in the strain relief (if
used), through the wire seal, and out the other side of the connector before stripping.
2. Carefully strip insulation 0.18 ± 0.02 inch (4.5 mm ± 0.5 mm). Unless insulation crimp is over-
tight, Automatic Wire Stripper J 35615 will remove insulation and crimp from old terminal with-
out damaging wire.
3. Place core crimp portion of terminal on bed of anvil “E” and squeeze crimper enough to keep
terminal from dropping (Figure C–2, View B).
4. Position wire core in terminal and squeeze crimper tool to complete the core crimp. Be sure to ori-
ent the terminal so that it is properly aligned with the terminal cavity in the connector. The
terminal should be positioned so that the lock tang is on the side of the cavity which has the notch
in the middle (for the remover tool).
5. Position insulation crimp of terminal on anvil “C” so that the entire insulation crimp area and a
portion of the terminal between the core and insulation crimp areas are supported by the anvil.
Complete the insulation crimp.
6. Be sure lock tang is lifted to allow proper reseating of the terminal.
7. Pull on the wire to pull the terminal completely into the cavity. (A click will be heard and the
terminal should stay in place if the wire is pushed.)

D. Terminal Crimping Using Alternate Tool J 35123


1. If a spare wire is used, the wire should be pushed through the proper hole in the strain relief (if
used) and the wire seal, and out the other side of the connector prior to stripping.
2. Insert remover tool in front side of connector to release locktab and push terminal out front
of connector. Pull the terminal and wire out the front of the connector to complete Steps (3)
through (7).
3. Push open the terminal holder on the crimper tool J 35123 and insert a terminal into the opening
marked 18–16 (Figure C–2, View C) so that the crimp ends point up. Release the terminal holder.
4. Slightly close the crimping tool (close until one click is heard) but do not start to crimp the terminal.
Place the terminal on the wire so it is in the same position as it will be when pulled back into the
connector. The terminal should be positioned so that the lock tang is on the side of the cavity which
has the notch in the middle (for the remover tool).
5. Insert the wire into the terminal until the wire contacts the holder. (By doing this, the core and
insulation should be properly positioned for the core and insulation crimp wings.)
6. Squeeze the crimper fully until it opens when released.
7. Open the terminal holder and remove the wire and terminal from the crimping tool.
8. Pull on the terminal to assure a tight crimp.
9. Be sure lock tang is lifted to allow proper reseating of the terminal.
10. Pull on the wire to pull the terminal completely into the cavity. (A click will be heard and the
terminal should stay in place if the wire is pushed.)

C–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–11


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

SECONDARY LOCK
P/N 12047664

TERMINAL
P/N 12047767
CONNECTOR
P/N 12047662

LOCK TANG REMOVER TOOL


J 35689-A

REMOVER
NOTCH

Lock terminal
here
SOCKET TERMINAL

WIRE

J 42215 CRIMPING TOOL


V04852

Figure C–3. Delphi-Packard Metri-Pack 150 Series Connector—Push-To-Seat


(Sump Temperature Thermistor)

C–12 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–3. DELPHI-PACKARD METRI-PACK 150 SERIES CONNECTORS—PUSH-TO-SEAT
(SUMP TEMPERATURE THERMISTOR)

A. Connector/Terminal Repairs:

Crimping Tool J 42215 (with terminal positioner removed)


Remover Tool J 35689-A
Use Description Manufacturers P/N
Sump Temperature Thermistor Sump Temperature Sensor 12129691
Connector, Black 12047662
Terminal 12047767
Secondary Lock 12047664

B. Terminal Removal:
1. Remove the secondary lock from the connector.
2. Insert needle end of terminal remover J 35689-A into the small notch in the front of the connector
cavity of the terminal to be removed (refer to Figure C–3).
3. Push the lock tang toward the terminal.
4. Pull the wire and terminal out of the connector.
5. Cut the terminal between the core and insulation crimp to minimize wire loss.

C. Terminal Crimping:
1. Strip insulation approximately 0.18 inch (4.5 mm).
2. Remove the spring-loaded terminal positioner from the J 42215 crimping tool.
3. Insert the new terminal to be crimped in the J 42215 crimping tool. Squeeze the crimper handles a
couple clicks to start the crimping process but leave room to insert the wire end.
4. Insert the bare wire end into the terminal. Squeeze the crimper handles to complete the crimping pro-
cess and until the crimper handles open when released to remove the terminal/wire from the tool.
5. Be sure the lock tang is positioned to allow proper retention of the terminal in the connector.
6. Push the terminal completely into the cavity. (A click will be heard and the terminal should stay in
place if the wire is pulled.)
7. Install the secondary lock in the connector.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–13


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

CONNECTOR WIRE
INSULATION CRIMP
WIRE INSULATION CORE CRIMP
TERMINAL

J 38125-13
REMOVER TOOL HOLDING PRONG
VIEW A VIEW B

CENTER LINE OF
THE CONNECTOR
SECONDARY
LOCK

VIEW C

SECONDARY
J 38125-6 LOCK CAP (TPA)
5
3
1
4
2

CABLE SEAL
SCI
CONNECTOR

INSULATION
WINGS
CORE CRIMP
TERMINAL

VIEW E
J 38125-7
E
C
A
D
B

VIEW D

V06608

Figure C–4. Delphi-Packard Metri-Pack 280 Series Connectors—Push-to-Seat (Diagnostic Tool Connector and SCI)

C–14 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–4. DELPHI-PACKARD METRI-PACK 280 SERIES CONNECTORS—PUSH-TO-SEAT
(DIAGNOSTIC TOOL CONNECTOR AND SCI)

A. Connector/Terminal Repairs
Crimping Tool J 38125-6 and 7
Wire Crimp Anvil “2”
Insulation Crimp Anvil “A”
Remover Tool J 38125-13
Use Description Manufacturers P/N
Diagnostic Connector Connector 12048105
Terminal (2-Wire) 12066214
Secondary Lock 12020219
Cover 12048107
SCI Connector Connector 15300027
Terminal (Socket) 12077411
Secondary Lock 15300014
Cable Seal 12089444
B. Terminal Removal
1. Remove secondary lock from back of connector (Figure C–4, View C or E). (Use a small
screwdriver or pick in the slots on each side of the connector.)
2. Insert remover tool J 38125-13 into open (front) end of connector at terminal to be serviced
(Figure C–4, View A).
3. Push the lock tang of the terminal straight and pull wire and terminal out the back of connector.
4. If the terminal is to be replaced, cut terminal between core and insulation crimp (this minimizes
wire length loss).
5. For the SCI connector (View E), be sure the cable seal is in correct position on the wire before
installing a new terminal.

C. Terminal Crimping
1. Carefully strip insulation 0.24 ± 0.01 inch (6.0 ± 0.25 mm).
2. Insert terminal into crimping tool (Figure C–4, View D), anvil “2.”
3. Slightly close crimping tool to hold the terminal steady.
4. Align the terminal with its position in the connector and insert wire so that the stripped portion
of the wire is in the core crimping area and the insulated portion of the wire is in the insulation
crimping area (Figure C–4, View B).
5. Crimp the stripped section of the wire (Figure C–4, View D).
6. Remove the terminal from the crimping tool.
7. Use a pair of needle nose pliers, if necessary, to start the bend on the insulation crimp wings
(Figure C–4, View D).
8. Crimp the insulated section of wire using anvil “A” of the crimpers shown (Figure C–4, View D).
9. Remove the terminal from the crimping tool.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–15


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C. Terminal Crimping (cont’d)
10. Tug on terminal to make sure the crimp is tight.
11. Insert terminal into connector with the locktab toward the center line of the connector (Figure C–4,
View C or E).
12. The terminal should “click” into place and you should not be able to pull the terminal out by hand.
13. Reinstall the secondary lock.

C–16 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–17


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

WIRE SEAL
CONNECTOR
TERMINAL SECONDARY LOCK

THROTTLE SENSOR
CONNECTOR

J 38125-10
REMOVER TOOL

VIEW A VIEW B

WIRE SEAL

CORE CRIMP
INSULATED WIRE

STRIPPED WIRE

VIEW C

WIRE SEAL
CORE CRIMP

TERMINAL
INSULATION AND SEAL CRIMP

VIEW D
5
3
1

J 38125-6
3
1
4
2

4
2

VIEW E
V01689

Figure C–5. Delphi-Packard WeatherPack Connector (TPS)

C–18 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–5. DELPHI-PACKARD WEATHERPACK CONNECTORS (TPS)

A. Connector/Terminal Repairs

Crimping Tool J 38125-6


Wire Crimp Anvil “2”
Insulation Crimp Anvil “5”
Alternate Crimping Tool J 35606 or J 38852
Remover Tool J 38125-10
Use Description Manufacturers P/N
Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) Connector 12015793
Terminal 12089040
Wire Seal 12015284 or 12089444

B. Terminal Removal
1. Unlatch and open the secondary lock on the connector (Figure C–5, View A).
2. On the front of the connector, insert remover tool J 38125-10 over the terminal. Push the tool over
the terminal and pull the terminal out of the back end of the connector (Figure C–5, View B).
3. If terminal is to be replaced, cut terminal between core and insulation crimp (this minimizes
wire loss).

NOTE: Two special tools are available for this operation: tool J 38125-6 (Paragraph C); tool J 35606 or
J 38852 (Paragraph D).

C. Terminal Crimping Using Crimping Tool J 38125-6


1. Place the wire seal onto the wire before stripping the wire (Figure C–5, View C).
2. Strip wire to 0.24 ± 0.01 inch (6.0 ± 0.25 mm).
3. Place terminal onto crimping tool J 38125-6 (Figure C–5, View E), anvil “2.”
4. Slightly close crimping tool to hold terminal steady.
5. Insert wire so that the stripped portion of wire is in the core crimp area and the insulated portion of
the wire is in the insulation crimping area (Figure C–5, View C).
6. Crimp the stripped section of the wire.
7. Remove the terminal from the crimping tool.
8. Push the wire seal into the terminal (Figure C–5, View D). The second crimp will wrap around the
wire seal. This will seal the insulated area of wire.
9. Use a pair of needle nose pliers, if necessary, to squeeze the terminal wings together to fit
in anvil “5.”
10. Crimp wire seal in anvil “5.”
11. Tug on terminal and be sure the crimp is tight.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–19


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C. Terminal Crimping Using Crimping Tool J 38125-6 (cont’d)
12. Insert the terminal into the connector. The terminal will “click” into place and should not pull out.
13. Secure the secondary lock. Both sides of the connector must be latched.

D. Terminal Crimping Using Alternate Crimper Pliers J 35606 or J 38852


1. Place the wire seal onto the wire before stripping the wire (Figure C–5, View C).

2. Strip wire to 0.24 ± 0.01 inch (6.0 ± 0.25 mm).

3. Insert terminal into crimping tool J 35606 (Figure C–6, View A), opening marked 18–20.

4. Position the terminal so the crimp wings are pointing up from the bottom jaw of the crimper and
are properly positioned.

5. Slightly close the crimping tool to hold the terminal steady.

6. Slide the wire seal to the edge of the insulation and insert the wire and seal into the terminal
(Figure C–6, View B).

7. Position the wire and seal and squeeze the crimping tool until it opens when released.

8. Tug on terminal to be sure the crimp is tight.

9. Insert terminal into connector. The terminal will “click” into place and should not pull out.

10. Relatch the secondary lock. Both sides of the connector must be latched.

Figure C–6. Terminal Crimping With Tool J 35606

C–20 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–21


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

BACKSHELL

CONVOLUTE CONDUIT

SHRINK TUBING
GROMMET

WIRE
PIN TERMINAL

RECEPTACLE

VIEW A

J 34182 CRIMPER

TO ROT
ISE A
RA

TE

SEL
NO.

REMOVER
J 38582-3 TERMINAL WIRE SIZE
INSPECTION HOLE INDICATOR

PIN TERMINAL

LOCKING RING
CAVITY PLUG DEPTH ADJUSTMENT SCREW

VIEW B

V06609

Figure C–7. Deutsch Connector (6-Way Optional Diagnostic Tool Connector or Optional DDU)

C–22 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–6. DEUTSCH CONNECTOR (6-WAY OPTIONAL DIAGNOSTIC TOOL CONNECTOR
OR OPTIONAL DDU)
A. Connector/Terminal Repairs

Crimping Tool J 34182


Remover Tool (DDR Connector) J 38582-3 (12–14 GA)
Use Description Manufacturers P/N
6-Way Optional DDR 6-Way Plug HD10-6-12P
Terminal (Pin) 0460-218-1231
Cavity Plug 114017
Backshell HD18-006
Cover (Cap) HDC16-6

B. Terminal Removal (Refer to Figure C–7, View A)


1. Loosen and slide the backshell along the convolute conduit.
2. Remove the convolute conduit from the base of the backshell follower. Peel enough conduit from
the harness to allow working access.
3. Slide the grommet clear of the receptacle housing.
4. Remove shrink tubing as necessary to allow working access.
5. Fully insert the proper remover/extractor tool into the back of the connector until it releases
the terminal.
6. Pull the terminal, wire, and tool out the back of the connector.
7. If replacing the terminal, cut the wire through the middle of the terminal crimp (this minimizes
wire loss).
C. Terminal Crimping (Refer to Figure C–7, View B)
1. Strip approximately 0.24–0.31 inch (6–8 mm) of insulation from the wire.
2. Set the crimping tool wire size to number 12. To set the wire size, remove the retainer pin. Lift and
rotate the indicator until the correct wire number is aligned with the SEL NO. arrow. Reinstall
the retainer pin.
3. Insert the contact end of the terminal into crimping tool J 34182. Adjust the crimping tool depth by
loosening the locking ring until the depth adjusting screw is free and turning the adjusting screw
until the top of the terminal is just above flush with the crimping hole (the crimp jaws will contact
the middle of the terminal barrel). Tighten the lock ring to retain the adjustment.
4. Fully insert the wire into the terminal so that the stripped portion of the wire is in the crimp area.
A small section (0.02–0.04 inch (0.5–1.0 mm)) of wire will be visible above the terminal barrel.
5. Squeeze the crimping tool handle until it releases. The terminal is now crimped onto the wire.
6. Remove the terminal and wire from the crimping tool.
7. Tug on the terminal to be sure the crimp is tight.
8. For the optional DDR connector, apply a one inch (25 mm) long piece of heat shrink tubing over
the wire insulation just behind the terminal. Apply heat to shrink and lock tubing to the insulation.
D. Terminal Insertion
1. Insert wire with crimped terminal through the proper hole in the grommet.
2. Keep pushing on wire until the terminal “locks” into position.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–23


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

J 41193-2 INSTALLER

J 41193-1
GUIDE PIN FOR SOCKET TERMINALS

35-WAY RECEPTACLE

J 41193-3 REMOVER

VIEW A

J 34182 CRIMPER

TO ROT
ISE A
RA

TE

SEL
NO.

WIRE SIZE INDICATOR


TERMINAL

LOCKING RING
DEPTH ADJUSTMENT SCREW
VIEW B

V06610

Figure C–8. ITT Cannon Connector—Crimped (35-Way T-Harness Bulkhead)

C–24 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–7. ITT CANNON CONNECTOR—CRIMPED (35-WAY T-HARNESS BULKHEAD)

A. Connector/Terminal Repair

Crimping Tool J 34182


Connector Repair Kit J 41193
Guide Pin J 41193-1
Insertion Tool J 41193-2
Terminal Remover J 41193-3

Use Description Manufacturers P/N


T-Harness Bulkhead 35-Way Receptacle 3100-F28-15S
Terminal (Socket) 031-0560-161
Cavity Plug 225-0017-000
35-Way Plug 3106-F28-15P
Terminal (Pin) 330-0351-016

B. Terminal Removal (Refer to Figure C–8, View A)


1. Select the J 41193-3 remover tool.
2. Choose either the pin or socket terminal remover tip and lock it into the handle.
3. Place the tip of the remover tool over the pin or into the socket and push the contact/terminal out
the rear of the connector using slow, even pressure.
4. Pull the wire and terminal out the back of the connector.
5. If replacing the terminal, cut the wire through the middle of the terminal crimp to minimize wire
loss.

C. Terminal Crimping (Refer to Figure C–8, View B)


1. Strip approximately 0.24–0.31 inch (6–8 mm) of insulation from the wire.
2. Set the crimping tool wire size to number 16. To set the wire size, remove the retainer pin. Lift and
rotate the indicator until 16 is aligned with the SEL NO. arrow. Reinstall the retainer pin.
3. Insert the contact end of the terminal down into crimping tool J 34182. Adjust the crimping tool
depth by loosening the locking ring until the depth adjusting screw is free and turning the adjusting
screw until the wire end of the terminal is just above flush with the top of the crimping hole. The
crimp jaws will now contact the middle of the terminal barrel. Tighten the lock ring to retain the
adjustment.
4. Fully insert the wire into the terminal so that the stripped portion of the wire is in the crimp area. A
small section (0.020–0.040 inch (0.5–1.0 mm)) of wire will be visible above the terminal barrel.
5. Squeeze the crimping tool handle until it releases. The terminal is now crimped onto the wire.
6. Remove the terminal and wire from the crimping tool.
7. Tug on the terminal to be sure the crimp is tight.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–25


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
D. Terminal Insertion
1. Select the proper insertion tool for the connector or receptacle that is being reassembled.
2. Place the terminal and wire in the insertion tool (refer to Figure C–8, View A).
3. Insert the terminal through the correct hole in the back of the connector and push until the terminal
is seated. Remove the insertion tool. Check to see that the terminal is at the same height as other
terminals. Tug on the wire at the rear of the connector to be sure the terminal is locked in place.
4. Insert cavity plugs into all unused cavities.

C–26 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–27


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

DESOLDERING BRAID
PEN SOLDERING IRON

SOLDERED CUP CONNECTION THREADED BACKSHELL


WIRE GROMMET

SOLDERING
IRON

SOLDERING
IRON WIRE

SOLDERING
IRON

SOLDER SOLDER

0.30 in. (0.8 mm)

• Tinning stripped wire • Soldering iron on side of cup • Soldering iron on side of cup
• Fill cup half full • Flow solder in cup
• Insert wire
• Maintain heat to flow solder
L06611

Figure C–9. ITT Cannon Connectors—Soldered (Main Valve Body Internal Harness, Main Valve Body Harness,
Lockup Body Harness, Trim Boost or Low Body Harness)

C–28 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–8. ITT CANNON CONNECTORS—SOLDERED (MAIN VALVE BODY INTERNAL
HARNESS, MAIN VALVE BODY HARNESS, LOCKUP BODY HARNESS, TRIM
BOOST OR LOW BODY HARNESS)

A. Connector Terminal Repair (Refer to Figure C–9)

Use Description Manufacturers P/N


Main Valve Body Internal Harness Jam-Nut Receptacle (16-Pin) MS3114E20-16P
Main Valve Body Harness Straight Plug (16-Socket) KPT-06-F20-16S
Lockup Body Harness Straight Plug (4-Socket) KPT-06-F8-4S
Trim Boost or Low Body Harness Straight Plug (5-Socket) KPT-06-F14-5S

B. Special Tools
• 50–70 percent tin resin core solder, 18–20 SWG (0.036 to 0.040 inch (0.086–1.0 mm))
• Pen-type soldering iron (60W maximum)—tip no larger than 0.125 inch (3.175 mm)
• Desoldering braid

NOTE: Proper solder, techniques, equipment, and cleanliness are important to achieve a good solder joint.
Before beginning any desoldering or soldering, tin the tip of the soldering iron. Clean connector and
terminals being soldered of all dirt, grease, and oil. Always heat the piece onto which solder is to flow.
A cold solder joint can cause intermittent continuity problems. Avoid a cold solder joint by heating the
piece(s) being soldered to melt the solder rather than merely heating the solder until it melts. Excess
solder applied to a stranded wire travels up the wire, stiffening it and making it inflexible. The wire
can break at the point where the solder stops. Do not use acid core solder.

C. Wire Removal—Desoldering
1. Unscrew the connector’s backshell and slide the backshell away from the connector.
2. Use a small screwdriver to slide the grommet away from the connector. Slide the grommet far
enough to allow access to the terminals and wire ends. If the grommet is hard to slide, lubricate the
wires with isopropyl alcohol. If necessary, move some of the harness covering. If no solder is
present, proceed as in Section 1–7 for crimped terminals.
3. Place the desoldering braid (wick) on top of the soldered terminal cup and wire. Place the hot sol-
dering iron on the desoldering braid and wait until the solder wicks up the braid. Remove the wire.
4. If other terminals are being repaired, repeat the desoldering operation as required.
5. Remove the wires from the grommet.
D. Soldering Wire Into Terminal

NOTE: If installing a new connector on a harness, be sure the backshell and grommet are in place before
soldering the wires to the terminals. Clean wires and terminals to remove all dirt or grease.

1. Strip approximately 0.31 ± 0.03 inch (8 ± 0.8 mm) of insulation from the wire.
2. Tin the stripped end of the wire.
3. Insert the wire through the proper hole in the grommet.

NOTE: Lubricate the wire(s) with isopropyl alcohol only if the wire(s) will not slide through the grommet. If
installing a new connector on the harness, be sure the backshell is in place before inserting the wire(s)
through the grommet.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–29


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
D. Soldering Wire Into Terminal (cont’d)
4. Mount the connector in a holding fixture at a 45 degree angle. Hold the solder in the terminal cup
and apply heat to the side of the cup until the solder flows. If a new connector is being used, begin
soldering at the bottom center connection and work up and out from there.
5. Slowly feed solder into the cup until it is half-full. When the cup is half-full, remove the solder
supply before removing the soldering iron. Half-fill all cup terminals that are to have wires
inserted.

NOTE: Feed solder slowly enough to prevent a flux gas pocket from forming. A gas pocket prevents sufficient
solder from flowing into the cup—a false fill. Correct a false fill by reheating the cup and adding
solder.

6. Start at the lowest cup and apply heat to the side of the cup until the solder melts.

NOTE: Do not overheat the connector while soldering. If the connector gets too hot, stop work until it cools.

7. Carefully insert the stripped end of the wire into the cup until the wire bottoms in the cup. The
wire’s insulation should be approximately 0.0625 inch (1.59 mm) above the solder.
8. Maintain heat until the solder has flowed in the cup and onto the wire. Overheating can cause the
solder to wick up the stranded wire.

NOTE: Indications of a good solder connection are:

• A minimum amount of solder showing

• Wire strands are clearly outlined in the joint

• The joint is completely covered with solder

• Fillets have a smooth even contour

• Edges are feathered

• The joint is bright, smooth, and appears clean

Too little solder is better than too much. If the solder wicks up the wire, the wire may break at the point
at which the solder stops.

9. After soldering and inspecting all connections, remove flux residue with a contact cleaner.
10. Slide the grommet into place and screw on the backshell.

C–30 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
NOTES

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–31


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

WEDGELOCK

CONNECTOR SEAL

CONNECTOR

Shrink tubing goes here

STANDARD SOCKET
TERMINAL

Extended terminal for


uninsulated shield wire

J 34182 CRIMPER

TO ROT
ISE A
RA

TE

SEL
NO.

WIRE SIZE INDICATOR


TERMINAL

LOCKING RING
DEPTH ADJUSTMENT SCREW

V03424

Figure C–10. Deutsch DT Series Connector (3-Way J1939 Interface)

C–32 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–9. DEUTSCH DT SERIES CONNECTOR (3-WAY J1939 INTERFACE)

A. Connector/Terminal Repair

Crimping Tool J 34182


Use Description Manufacturers P/N
J1939 Interface Connector, Plug, 3-Way DT06-3S-E008
Wedgelock, Plug W3S-1939
Contact, Socket (Standard) 100504-23
Contact, Socket (Extended) 0462-221-1631
Cable, J1939 Databus 23-000-13

B. Terminal Removal (Refer to Figure C–10)


1. Use a small-bladed screwdriver to remove the wedgelock that holds the terminals in place.
2. Use a sharp knife to carefully remove the shrink tubing from the rear of the connector plug.
3. Use a small screwdriver to release the locking lever for all of the terminals. Pull the wire and
terminal out the rear of the connector.
4. Slide a new piece of shrink tubing over the removed terminals and onto the cable.
5. If replacing the terminal, cut the wire through the middle of the terminal crimp to minimize wire
loss.

C. Terminal Crimping (Refer to Figure C–10)


1. Strip 0.24–0.31 inch (6–8 mm) of insulation from the wire. (There is no insulation on the
shield wire.)
2. Set the crimping tool wire size to number 18. To set the wire size, remove the retainer pin. Lift and
rotate the indicator until 18 is aligned with the SEL NO. arrow. Reinstall the retainer pin.
3. Insert the contact end of the terminal down into crimping tool J 34182. Adjust the crimping tool
depth by loosening the locking ring until the depth adjusting screw is free and turning the adjusting
screw until the wire end of the terminal is just above flush with the top of the crimping hole. The
depth adjustment screw will need to be backed out a large amount to accept the extended shield
terminal. The crimp jaws will now contact the middle of the terminal barrel. Tighten the lock ring
to retain the adjustment.
4. Fully insert the wire into the terminal so that the stripped portion of the wire is in the crimp area. A
small section (0.02–0.04 inch (0.5–1.0 mm)) of wire will be visible above the terminal barrel.
5. Squeeze the crimping tool handle until it releases. The terminal is now crimped onto the wire.
6. Remove the terminal and wire from the crimping tool.
7. Tug on the terminal to be sure the crimp is tight.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–33


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
D. Terminal Insertion
1. Slide the wire with crimped terminal attached into the rear of the connector.
2. Push the terminal and wire into the connector until it locks into position (refer to Figure C–10).
Check the front of the connector to see that the terminal is at the same height as other terminals.
Tug on the wire at the rear of the connector to be sure the terminal is locked in place.
3. Insert the wedge lock to hold the terminals in place. Slide the sealing plug back into place at the
rear of the connector.
4. Slide the shrink tubing over the raised area at the rear of the connector. Use a heat gun to shrink the
tubing into position over the connector and cable.

C–34 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
C–10. REPAIR OF A BROKEN WIRE WITH IN-LINE BUTT SPLICE
A. Connector Check Before Repair

NOTE: Before repairing or replacing wiring harness, sensor, solenoid, switch, or ECU as indicated for a
diagnosed problem, follow the procedure below:

1. Disconnect the connector or connectors associated with the problem and inspect for:
• Bent terminals
• Broken terminals
• Dirty terminals
• Pushed back terminals
• Missing terminals
• Condition of mating tabs
• Condition of mating terminals
Be Sure terminals are secure in the connector. Clean, straighten, or replace parts as required.

2. Reconnect all previous unmated connectors. Be Sure connectors are fully inserted or twisted until
they lock in place. Connectors with locking tabs make an audible “click” when the lock is engaged.
3. If trouble recurs after starting the vehicle, follow proper repair procedures for trouble code or
complaint.
4. If trouble does not recur, or if the correct repairs and/or replacements have been made, the problem
should be corrected.

B. Special Tools
• Heat Gun, J 25070 or equivalent
• Crimping Tool for Pre-insulated Crimp J 38125-8 (refer to Figure C–11)

NOTE: Use crimping anvils “F” and “G.”

• Wire Strippers, J 35615


• Splices P/N 23046604 14–16 AWG
• Splices P/N 23046605 18–22 AWG

NOTE: Each splice must be properly crimped and then heated to shrink the covering to protect and insulate
the splice. Insulation piercing splice clips should not be used.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. C–35


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX C—CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART


NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS

J 38125-8
F
G

V01694

Figure C–11. Crimper J 38125-8

C. Straight Lead Repair Procedure


1. Locate damaged wire.
2. Remove insulation 0.3 inch (8.0 mm).
3. Insert one wire into crimp barrel and crimp.
4. Insert other wire into crimp barrel and crimp.
5. Pull on connection to be sure of crimping integrity.
6. Heat splice with heat gun until covering shrinks and adhesive flows from under the covering.
7. The splice is now sealed and insulated. Electrical tape should not be used and is not necessary.

C–36 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


MATING
CONNECTOR MFG. P/N PART NAME MANUFACTURER CONFIG MFG. P/N MATING PART NAME
P/N
ECU S 12191001 STRAIN RELIEF, 32-WAY BLACK DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU S 12186041 12186041 ECU HEADER
ECU S 15305333 SEAL, 32-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU S
ECU S 15305371 INNER CONNECT, 32-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU S
ECU S 12129021 TPA, 32-WAY BLACK DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU S
ECU S 12084912 TERMINAL, SOCKET 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU S
ECU S 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU S
ECU S 12177289 CPA, 32-WAY RED DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU S
ECU V 12191002 STRAIN RELIEF, 32-WAY GRAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU V 12186043 12186043 ECU HEADER
ECU V 15305333 SEAL, 32-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU V
ECU V 15305371 INNER CONNECT, 32-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU V
ECU V 12129022 TPA, 32-WAY GRAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU V
ECU V 12084912 TERMINAL, SOCKET 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU V
ECU V 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU V
ECU V 12177289 CPA, 32-WAY RED DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU V
ECU T 12191003 STRAIN RELIEF, 32-WAY BLUE DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU T 12129008 12129008 ECU HEADER
ECU T 15305333 SEAL, 32-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU T
ECU T 15305371 INNER CONNECT, 32-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU T
ECU T 12129023 TPA, 32-WAY BLUE DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU T
ECU T 12084912 TERMINAL, SOCKET 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU T
ECU T 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU T
ECU T 12177289 CPA, 32-WAY RED DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/ECU T
PSS/SSS 12160280 CONN 20F MIC/P 100W GRAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12160542 12160542 CONN 20M MIC/P 100W GRAY
PSS/SSS 15304882 CABLE SEAL, 14F GRAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12110693 12110693 CABLE SEAL, 14M GREEN
PSS/SSS 12160494 LOCK, SECONDARY 20F GREEN DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12191176 12191176 LOCK ASSIST/SEAL, 20M GREEN
PSS/SSS 12084912 TERMINAL, SOCKET 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12160551 12160551 TERMINAL, PIN 100W

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


PSS/SSS 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12129557 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W
PSS/SSS 12176394 CONDUIT CLIP, 13 mm BLACK DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12176394 12176394 CONDUIT CLIP, 13 mm BLACK
DDR P 12048105 CONNECTOR, 12-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER
DDR P 12048107 COVER, CONNECTOR DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S
DDR P 12034046 TERMINAL, 280F SPECIAL DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S
DDR P 12066214 TERMINAL, 280F (W/SCI), 2-WIRE DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S
DDR P 12020219 LOCK, SECONDARY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S
DDR D HD10-6-12P CONNECTOR, REC., 6-WAY DEUTSCH IPD 1-PC/COMP S DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER
DDR D 0460-256-12233 CONTACT, PIN #12 DEUTSCH IPD 1-PC/COMP S
DDR D 0460-204-0831 CONTACT, PIN #8 DEUTSCH IPD 1-PC/COMP S
DDR D 114017 SEALING PLUG DEUTSCH IPD 1-PC/COMP S
DDR D HD18-006 BACKSHELL - STRAIN RELIEF DEUTSCH IPD 1-PC/COMP S
APPENDIX C — CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART
NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

DDR D HDC16-6 CAP, DDR CONNECTOR DEUTSCH IPD 1-PC/COMP S


SCI 15300027 CONNECTOR, 2-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 15300002 15300002 CONNECTOR, 2-WAY
SCI 12077411 TERMINAL, SOCKET DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12048159 12048159 TERMINAL, PIN

C–37
MATING
CONNECTOR MFG. P/N PART NAME MANUFACTURER CONFIG MFG. P/N MATING PART NAME
P/N

C–38
SCI 12089444 SEAL, WIRE TYPE, SILICONE DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12089444 12089444 SEAL, WIRE TYPE, SILICONE
SCI 15300014 LOCK, SECONDARY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 15300014 15300014 LOCK, SECONDARY
J1939 DT06-3S-E008 CONNECTOR, PLUG 3-WAY DEUTSCH 1-PC/ECU S DT04-3P-E008 CONNECTOR, REC., 3-WAY
J1939 W3S WEDGELOCK, PLUG DEUTSCH 1-PC/ECU S W3P WEDGELOCK, RECEPTACLE
J1939 3662-204-1690 CONTACT, SOCKET #16 DEUTSCH 1-PC/ECU S 29511369 3660-201-1690 CONTACT, PIN #16
J1939 0462-221-1631 CONTACT, EXTENDED SOCKET DEUTSCH 1-PC/ECU S 0460-247-1631 CONTACT, EXTENDED PIN
J1939 CABLE, J1939 DATABUS 1-PC/ECU S
VIM 12040920 CONNECTOR, BODY, 18-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V 12052130 12052130 VIM HEADER ASSEMBLY
VIM 12040936 SEAL, 9-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V
VIM 12110545 STRAIN RELIEF, 18-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V
VIM 12129426 BOLT, 7mm HEAD EXT. DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V
VIM 12034236 RETAINER CLIP, BOLT DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V
VIM 12103881 TERMINAL, 150F DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V
VIM 12034413 CAVITY PLUG, METRI-PACK DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V
VIW S 12160542 CONN 20M MIC/P 100W GRAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12160280 12160280 CONN 20F MIC/P 100W GRAY
VIW S 12110693 CABLE SEAL, 14M GREEN DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 15304882 15304882 CABLE SEAL, 14F GRAY
VIW S 12191178 LOCK ASSIST/SEAL, 20M WHITE DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12191173 12191173 LOCK, SECONDARY 20F WHITE
VIW S 12160551 TERMINAL, PIN 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12084912 12084912 TERMINAL, SOCKET 100W
VIW S 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12129557 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W
VIW S 12176394 CONDUIT CLIP, 13 mm BLACK DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP S 12176394 12176394 CONDUIT CLIP, 13 mm BLACK
VIW V 12160542 CONN 20M MIC/P 100W GRAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V 12160280 12160280 CONN 20F MIC/P 100W GRAY
VIW V 12110693 CABLE SEAL, 14M GREEN DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V 15304882 15304882 CABLE SEAL, 14F GRAY
VIW V 12191177 LOCK ASSIST/SEAL, 20M BLUE DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V 12191172 12191172 LOCK, SECONDARY 20F BLUE
VIW V 12160551 TERMINAL, PIN 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V 12084912 12084912 TERMINAL, SOCKET 100W
VIW V 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V 12129557 12129557 CAVITY PLUG, 100W
VIW V 12176394 CONDUIT CLIP, 13 mm BLACK DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V 12176394 12176394 CONDUIT CLIP, 13 mm BLACK

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


VIW V 12191505 COVER, CONNECTOR DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V
NE 12162193 CONNECTOR, 2-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP T 12066016 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR
NE 12103881 TERMINAL, 150F DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP T Actual sensor uses molded receptacle similar to 12066016
NO 12162193 CONNECTOR, 2-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP T OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR
NO 12103881 TERMINAL, 150F DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP T Actual sensor uses molded receptacle similar to 12066016
NT 12162193 CONNECTOR, 2-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP T TURBINE SPEED SENSOR
NT 12103881 TERMINAL, 150F DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP T Actual sensor uses molded receptacle similar to 12066016
TPS 12015793 CONNECTOR, 3-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V,T TPS HEADER
TPS 12089040 TERMINAL, PIN DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V,T TPS header similar to 12010717 connector with 12089188 sockets
TPS 12089444 SEAL, WIRE TYPE, SILICONE DELPHI-PACKARD 1-PC/COMP V,T molded into the TPS.
SCIX 15300002 CONNECTOR, SHROUD 2-WAY DELPHI-PACKARD SCI ADAPTER 15300027 15300027 CONNECTOR, 2-WAY
APPENDIX C — CONNECTOR PART NUMBERS, TERMINAL PART
NUMBERS, TOOL PART NUMBERS, AND REPAIR INSTRUCTIONS
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

SCIX 12048159 TERMINAL, PIN DELPHI-PACKARD SCI ADAPTER 12077411 12077411 TERMINAL, SOCKET
SCIX 12089444 SEAL, WIRE TYPE, SILICONE DELPHI-PACKARD SCI ADAPTER 12089444 12089444 SEAL, WIRE TYPE, SILICONE
SCIX 15300014 LOCK, SECONDARY DELPHI-PACKARD SCI ADAPTER 15300014 15300014 LOCK, SECONDARY
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX D—THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ADJUSTMENT

A. Description of Operation (Figure D–1)


1. To properly communicate throttle position to the Electronic Control Unit (ECU), the throttle
position sensor (TPS) must convert its mechanical movement to an electrical form the ECU can
understand. To accomplish this, contacts move across a resistive strip inside the sensor which
translates position into voltage.

THROTTLE POSITION LINKAGE

CONTACTS

RESISTIVE STRIP

V00656.01

Figure D–1. Throttle Position to Voltage Conversion

2. Each position gives a different voltage. The ECU then converts the voltage to counts. Each count
corresponds to approximately 0.007 inch (0.179 mm) of throttle sensor movement. Figure D–2
diagrams the counts and throttle movement relationship.

Adjust so total stroke is within


0 COUNT
50–200 count band 255 COUNTS

14 COUNTS 233 COUNTS


ERROR ERROR
ZONE ZONE
50 COUNTS 200 COUNTS
APPROX.
0.75 in. (19 mm) STROKE

CLOSED WIDE OPEN


THROTTLE THROTTLE
FULLY FULLY
RETRACTED EXTENDED
(AT REST) Total Stroke
CT–WOT
0.1 in. 1.6 in.
(2.5 mm) 0.6 in.–0.9 in. (40.6 mm)
0 in.
(15.2 mm–22.9 mm) 1.8 in.
85–130 Counts (45.7 mm)
V00429.06

Figure D–2. Throttle Position Determination Diagram

3. Throttle percentage is proportional to counts; low counts correspond to low percent and high
counts correspond to high percent (refer to Table D–1).
4. The conversion from counts to percent throttle is performed easily once the idle and full throttle
positions are set (refer to adjustment procedures below). The idle and full throttle positions

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. D–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX D—THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ADJUSTMENT

correspond to counts which can be viewed with a diagnostic tool. The ECU determines percent
throttle by the equation:

Current Count—Idle Count


% Throttle = x 100
Full Throttle Count—Idle Count
Where:
Idle Count = Count on diagnostic tool when engine is idling.
Current Count = Count on diagnostic tool at the present throttle position.
Full Throttle Count = Count on diagnostic tool at wide open throttle.

NOTE: Refer to Appendix J for diagnostic tool user information.

5. The throttle position sensor is self-calibrating within its normal operating range. Each time the
vehicle is started and the ECU is initialized, the idle counts that are used for closed throttle are
increased by 15 counts from its previous lowest reading. Also, the wide open throttle counts are
reduced by 15 counts from its previous highest reading. Once new counts are read from the
current sensor position, the idle and wide open throttle count set points are continually
readjusted to the lowest and highest counts, respectively. This compensates for fuel control system
wear or previous mechanical adjustment. One area of particular concern is when the throttle sensor
extends into the error zone. This indicates a TPS misadjustment to the ECU and 100 percent throttle
is assumed until readjustment is performed. Simply clearing the code 21 XX will not resolve the
100 percent (WOT) shifting situation.

NOTE: After replacing or adjusting the throttle position sensor linkage, the technician should use the
diagnostic tool to clear the throttle calibration. Go to the diagnostic tool selection menu and locate
ACTION REQUESTS. Select RESET THROTTLE CALIBRATION and ENTER to set the 0 percent
throttle counts. After the idle counts are established, the throttle should be moved to the Full position
to establish the full or Wide Open Throttle (WOT) position (100 percent). The full throttle counts will
be the same as the idle counts until the throttle is moved. The full throttle counts are set when
maximum travel is reached so stopping before actual full throttle will set the 100 percent point
artificially low. Refer to Figure D–2 for proper counts and percentage. Refer to Figure D–3 for
illustration of throttle position adjustment.

B. Throttle Position Sensor (TPS) Adjustment


When properly installed by the equipment manufacturer, the TPS should not require adjustment.
Confirm that the throttle sensor is installed to manufacturer specifications before adjusting the
throttle position sensor. The idle count should be 50 or higher and full throttle count 200 or lower.
The TPS is self-calibrating meaning there is no optimum closed throttle or wide open throttle
count value. As long as the counts are within the 50 to 200 range, the TPS is set properly. Total stroke
of 85–130 counts must be maintained. Watch the movement of the throttle sensor as the controls
move it through its full stroke. Be sure there is no misalignment or obstruction to smooth movement
through the full stroke. Make certain the idle and full throttle positions are not in the error zones (refer
to Figure D–2). The error zones occur when the idle position is less than 14 counts, or when the full
throttle position is more than 233 counts. When idle or wide open throttle positions are in the error
zones, codes 21 12 and 21 23 occur, respectively. These codes cause the transmission to shift as if the
throttle is fully depressed (100 percent throttle) affecting shift quality and causing decreased fuel
efficiency. Code 21 XX may be caused by a short or open circuit in the chassis harness or by incorrect
voltages. If this occurs, refer to code 21 XX chart.

NOTE: Use Test Harness J 41339 for measuring voltages.

D–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX D—THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ADJUSTMENT

Table D–1. Volts Versus Count for Throttle Sensor Display Reading
CTS Volts CTS Volts CTS Volts CTS Volts CTS Volts CTS Volts
0 0 41 81 121 161 201
1 0.0196 42 82 122 162 202
2 43 83 123 163 203
3 44 84 124 164 204
4 45 0.882 85 1.666 125 2.451 165 3.235 205 4.019
5 0.098 46 86 126 166 206
6 47 87 127 167 207
7 48 88 128 168 208
8 49 89 129 169 209
9 50 0.98 90 1.764 130 2.549 170 3.333 210 4.117
10 0.196 51 91 131 171 211
11 52 92 132 172 212
12 53 93 133 173 213
13 54 94 134 174 214
14 55 1.078 95 1.863 135 2.647 175 3.431 215 4.215
15 0.276 56 96 136 176 216
16 57 97 137 177 217
17 58 98 138 178 218
18 59 99 139 179 219
19 60 1.176 100 1.96 140 2.745 180 3.529 220 4.313
20 0.392 61 101 141 181 221
21 62 102 142 182 222
22 63 103 143 183 223
23 64 104 144 184 224
24 65 1.274 105 2.058 145 2.843 185 3.627 225 4.411
25 0.49 66 106 146 186 226
26 67 107 147 187 227
27 68 108 148 188 228
28 69 109 149 189 229
29 70 1.372 110 2.156 150 2.941 190 3.725 230 4.509
30 0.588 71 111 151 191 231
31 72 112 152 192 232
32 73 113 153 193 233
33 74 114 154 194 234
34 75 1.47 115 2.225 155 3.039 195 3.823 235 4.607
35 0.686 76 116 156 196 236
36 77 117 157 197 237
37 78 118 158 198 238
38 79 119 159 199 239
39 80 1.568 120 2.353 160 3.137 200 3.921 240 4.705
40 0.784

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. D–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX D—THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR ADJUSTMENT

MOUNTING PROVISION: BENDING LOAD


Use M6 x 1.00 or 1⁄4-20 in. series bolts APPLIED
3 places
Torque M6 x 1.00 bolt to 84–120 lb in. (10–13 N•m)
Torque 1⁄4-20 in. series bolts to 108–132 lb in. (13–14 N•m) UNACCEPTABLE INSTALLATION
Mount to a solid frame member. Flatness of
chassis mounting surface must not exceed 10.0° MAX INSTALLED
0.03 in. (0.8 mm). OPERATING ANGLE
IN ALL DIRECTIONS

LOADING IN
TENSION ONLY

ACCEPTABLE INSTALLATION
Attachment must provide freedom
of motion to allow cable loading in
tension only (no bending loads).
WIRING HARNESS
2.17 in. (55.0 mm)
MIN required Fuel control must not move
the throttle sensor beyond R 6.00 in. (152.0 mm) MIN
for connection
the closed throttle position ALLOWANCE RADIUS
removal
at any time.
FULLY EXTENDED
FORCE REQUIRED FULLY
6.0 lb (26.7 N) MAX RETRACTED

MOUNTING (NOTE: Mounting length


1.87 in. (47.5 mm) CLOSED THROTTLE LENGTH + 2 inches (50.8 mm) equals
3.75 in. (95.2 mm) cable length)
FULL THROTTLE
4.65 in. (118.1 mm)
OPERATING BAND 0.6 – 0.9 in.
4.65 in. (15.2 – 22.9 mm)
(118.1 mm) The location of the
3.75 in. clamping bracket relative
(95.2 mm) to the fuel lever at closed
throttle must be maintained
within this range.

Attach to engine or governor


1.19 in. (30.2 mm) 3.679 in. (93.45 mm)housing using clamp and shims as
3.431 in. (87.15 mm)required. Clamp must positively
lock in cable groove.
Fuel lever attachment linkage or bracket must HITCH PIN CLIP
allow fuel lever to return to closed throttle position
ENGINE FUEL LEVER
when sensor rod is maintained at full throttle position.
Attach the throttle sensor directly to the engine fuel
lever with no breakover or yield linkages between the
engine fuel lever shaft and the attachment point of the
throttle sensor. CLOSED THROTTLE 7.21 in. (183.1 mm) MAX
FULL THROTTLE
Same as without 6.31 in. (160.2 mm) MIN
SLIP-LINK
FULLY EXTENDED

1.50 in. (38.1 mm)

HITCH PIN CLIP


FULLY RETRACTED

OPTIONAL THROTTLE SENSOR ASSEMBLY WITH SLIP-LINK V00430.08

Figure D–3. Throttle Position Sensor Adjustment

D–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX E—WELDING ON VEHICLE/VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE

E–1. WELDING ON VEHICLE


When frame or other welding is required on the vehicle, take the following precautions to protect the electronic
control components:

1. Disconnect the wiring harness connectors at the transmission electronic control unit.
2. Disconnect the positive and negative battery connections, and any electronic control ground wires
connected to the frame or chassis.
3. Cover electronic control components and wiring to protect them from hot sparks, etc.
4. Do not connect welding cables to electronic control components.

Do not jump start a vehicle with arc welding equipment. Arc welding
WARNING! equipment’s dangerously high currents and voltages cannot be reduced to safe
levels.

E–2. VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE


The Allison Vehicle Interface Module (VIM) containing all Allison system relays and fuses can be used as the
interface to all vehicle wiring. Refer to Figure E–2 for VIM component location and pin-out. To close an open
VIM, tighten the bolts in the numerical order shown in Figure E–1 to provide a sealed, water-tight box. Torque the
bolts to 4–6 lb ft (5–8 N·m).

6
7

4
3

5 8

V00657

Figure E–1. Vehicle Interface Module

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. E–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX E—WELDING ON VEHICLE/VEHICLE INTERFACE MODULE

(K4) (K5) (K6)


WIRE 132/GPO 1 WIRE 114/GPO 4 WIRE 125/GPO 9
E3/30 A3/30
M1/18 C1/30 R3/18 C1/30 C1/30 N2/18
D2/30 B2/30 D1/30

R1/18 R1/18 R1/18


E2/30 A2/30 E1/30

C1/30 F1/18
IGNITION FUSE

(K1) (K2) (K3)


WIRE 113/REVERSE WARNING WIRE 123/NEUTRAL START WIRE 112/GPO 7 or 32
A1/30 F1/30 F3/30
R2/18 C1/30 P1/18 L1 & 2/18 P2/18 K1 & 2/30
(+) (–) C2/30

R1/18 K1 & 2/30


B1/30 G1/30 F2/30

J1 & 2/30 E1 & 2/18


MAIN FUSE

1 1

2 2

3 3
L M N P R S TERMINAL BOARD
A B C D E F G H J K A B C D E F IDENTIFICATION
HARNESS
30-WAY CONNECTOR 18-WAY CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
(PIN ID/30) (PIN ID/18) IDENTIFICATION
See page B-20 for See page B-19 for
wire/terminal usage. wire/terminal usage.

87
86
87A 85

30

Pin numbering on
bottom of relay

Ignition fuse must be in place and not open for there to be


continuity between pins C1/30 and S1/18

V06646.00.01

Figure E–2. VIM Components Location and Pin-Out Diagram

E–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX F—HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS

Figure Description Page No.


F–1 5610, 6610 Models — Hydraulic Schematic F–3/F–4
F–2 8610 Model — Hydraulic Schematic F–5/F–6
F–3 M 9610 Models — Hydraulic Schematic F–7/F–8
F–4 S 9805M, S 9810 Models — Hydraulic Schematic F–9/F–10

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. F–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX F—HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS

NOTES

F–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX F—HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS

SHIFT
SELECTOR SOLENOIDS CLUTCHES
Intermediate Clutch POSITION ENERGIZED ENGAGED
Splitter Splitter High Clutch (Third-and- Low Clutch
Low High (Fifth-and- Fourth Range) (First-and-
Clutch Clutch 6 E, G✽ HIGH, SPLITTER HIGH
Sixth Range) Second Range) 5 E, F HIGH, SPLITTER LOW
4 D, G✽ INTERMEDIATE, SPLITTER HIGH
Reverse
Clutch 3 D, F INTERMEDIATE, SPLITTER LOW
2 C, G✽ LOW, SPLITTER HIGH
1 C, F LOW, SPLITTER LOW
N A✽, F SPLITTER LOW
R1 A✽, B, F SPLITTER LOW, REVERSE
R2 A✽, B, G✽ SPLITTER HIGH, REVERSE

NOTES: VALVE POSITIONS SHOWN ARE WITH TRANSMISSION


IN NEUTRAL WITH ENGINE RUNNING
✽ NOT USED IN MODELS WITH LOCK—IN—NEUTRAL

MAIN PRESSURE EXHAUST OR SUMP


CONVERTER–IN SPLITTER–LOW
CONVERTER–OUT SOLENOID PRESSURE
LUBRICATION

LOCKUP PRESSURE SPLITTER–HIGH

Ground Solenoid
Sleeve SPLITTER–LOW SPLITTER–LOW Pressure
Tap
This Ground
Sleeve Vent is TO CONVERTER
FROM
Open for all Solenoid
FILTERS
TC Series Pressure
except TC682 LOW DIFF. PRESSURE Solenoid F Regulator
A

REVERSE
& TC683 Differential Valve
C Solenoid B Solenoid C Solenoid D Solenoid E Priority
Pressure B
Switch Valve
HIGH DIFF. PRESSURE Low
Pressure
TO FILTERS Tap
Reverse ORIFICE ORIFICE
Converter Reverse Low Shift Intermediate High
Filter Pressure Shift ORIFICE Valve Shift Valve Shift ORIFICE ORIFICE
Pressure Bypass Tap ORIFICE ORIFICE
Valve Valve ORIFICE
Relief Valve Splitter Low
80 psi Main Pressure Pressure ORIFICE
(552 kPa) Regulator Tap

Splitter High
ORIFICE High
Lockup Pressure
Pressure PIPE
Pressure Tap ORIFICE Tap
Oil ORIFICE PLUG
Cooler Tap
Splitter
Shift
Main Valve
VALVE ASSEMBLY Pressure
LOCATED ON TOP OF Port
CONVERTER HOUSING ORIFICE
Interm. ORIFICE (BLOCKED FOR
Speedo Pressure Tap (BLOCKED FOR LOCK–IN–NEUTRAL)
Gear Lube Exhaust Solenoid A✽ LOCK–IN–NEUTRAL)
Regulator
Valve Solenoid G✽
Input ORIFICES
Pump

Solenoid J
ORIFICE
Lockup (BLOCKED FOR
Shift Valve LOCK–IN–NEUTRAL) ORIFICE

ORIFICES Trimmer
Pressure ORIFICE
Sump Tap
Lube
Pressure ORIFICE ORIFICE ORIFICE ORIFICE
Regulator
22.5 psi
(155 kPa)

ORIFICE ORIFICE ORIFICE ORIFICE

Low Intermediate Trim Splitter Splitter


Reverse Range Range Boost High Low
ORIFICE Trimmer Trimmer Trimmer Regulator Trimmer Trimmer
Solenoid K Valve Valve Valve Valve Valve Valve
VALVE ASSEMBLY
LOCATED ON
CONVERTER HOUSING
MAIN PRESSURE
H03568

Figure F–1. 5610, 6610 Models—Hydraulic Schematic

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. F–3/F–4


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX F—HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS

DP8610
NEUTRAL OPERATION
1ST RANGE REVERSE RANGE
5TH -AND-6TH 3RD -AND-4TH
SPLITTER–LOW SPLITTER–HIGH RANGE RANGE 2ND RANGE

SHIFT SOLENOIDS
CLUTCHES ENGAGED
OPERATION ENERGIZED

1 F, H FIRST RANGE, SPLITTER LOW


2 C, F SECOND RANGE, SPLITTER LOW
3 D, F THIRD-AND-FOURTH RANGE, SPLITTER LOW
4 D, G* THIRD-AND-FOURTH RANGE, SPLITTER HIGH
5 E, F FIFTH-AND-SIXTH RANGE, SPLITTER LOW
D E, G* FIFTH-AND-SIXTH RANGE, SPLITTER HIGH
N A*, F, I* SPLITTER LOW
R A*, B, F, I* REVERSE RANGE, SPLITTER LOW

MAIN * NOT USED ON MODELS WITH LOCK-IN-NEUTRAL


CONVERTER – IN
CONVERTER – OUT Notes:
LUBRICATION Not Used for Lock—In—Neutral
**
EXHAUST OR SUMP
R, N, 1, 2 BOOSTER SPLITTER-LOW
ORIFICE
SPLITTER – LOW
SOLENOID PRESSURE
EX - DENOTES EXHAUST REVERSE

FROM RETARDER SOLENOID PRESSURE

TO RETARDER
Solenoid B Solenoid H Solenoid
Solenoid C Solenoid D Solenoid E Solenoid F Pressure
LOCKUP EX
Regulator
Priority Valve
EX EX Valve EX
Reverse EX ORIFICE EX EX EX
LUBRICATION ORIFICE
FROM CONVERTER

Shift
FROM RETARDER

Converter ORIFICE EX
Pressure ORIFICE Valve ORIFICE ORIFICE EX
ORIFICE ORIFICE ORIFICE
Relief Check EX
VALVE ASSEMBLY Valve
LOCATED ON SIDE OF Valve EX
CONVERTER HOUSING 100 psi 20 psi
Differential First
ON FROM
Range EX ORIFICE
FILTERS
OFF Shift
ORIFICES
LOW DIFF. PRESSURE **
ORIFICE Valve ORIFICE
Differential A
C EX
Pressure
Switch B
Lock-up EX
EX EX EX
HIGH DIFF. PRESSURE Pressure PIPE
Tap PLUG
TO FILTERS Splitter **
** Shift ORIFICE
EX Solenoid I EX ORIFICE
30 PSI
Filter Main Valve
CONVERTER OUT Second
Bypass Pressure ** Third / Fourth Fifth / Sixth
REGULATOR ORIFICE Range
Tap Range Shift Range Shift EX
Oil Main Pressure EX Solenoid Shift Valve Valve
Cooler Regulator Valve TO LUBE ORIFICE A Valve
Exhaust
TEMP Check
SENSOR Solenoid G
SUPPLY
Valve
EX
TO CONVERTER

TO RETARDER ORIFICE
FROM EX
COOLER EX ORIFICE
EX ORIFICE
BOOSTER Main
EX PLUG Pressure Lockup EX EX EX ORIFICE EX Splitter
Tap Solenoid K Shift Valve ORIFICES Trimmer Low
VALVE ASSEMBLY
ORIFICES ORIFICES Regulator Trimmer
MAIN

Hydraulic Retarder VALVE ASSEMBLY LOCATED ON Valve Valve


Control Valve LOCATED ON TOP OF CONVERTER HOUSING EX
CONVERTER HOUSING MAIN
Input ORIFICE EX
Pump
First /
Reverse ORIFICE
Trimmer
Valve EX

R, N, 1, 2 BOOSTER
MAIN
Oil Sump
V05498.01

Figure F–2. 8610 Models—Hydraulic Schematic

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. F–5/F–6


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX F—HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS

Figure F–3. M 9610 Models—Hydraulic Schematic

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. F–7/F–8


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX F—HYDRAULIC SCHEMATICS

Figure F–4. S 9805M, S 9810 Models—Hydraulic Schematic

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. F–9/F–10


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

INPUT
(ENGINE)
SPEED
SENSOR
B
A
150 – T30
141 – T14
ORANGE
TAN ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC VEHICLE INTERFACE
WIRING CONNECTOR
(VIW-V)
INPUT VEHICLE INTERFACE HARNESS

OUTPUT B
148 – T32 GREEN
5/6/8/9000 CEC2 A
B
(–) INPUT WIRE # 155
(–) INPUT WIRE # 153
MANUAL L/U-PARK BRAKE ENABLE
TWO SPEED AXLE INPUT
STALL CHECK
SPEED 139 – T16 YELLOW C
(+) INPUT WIRE # 118
SHIFT SELECTOR
A
SENSOR BULKHEAD ECU ECU 135G-V24
N
ANALOG GROUND TRANSITION
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR
(OPTIONAL) “T” “V” (–) INPUT WIRE # 137 NEUTRAL TO RANGE INHIBIT
U
(BLUE) (GRAY) (–) INPUT WIRE # 117 DELTA-P HOLD
TURBINE P
140C – T31 BLUE
B (–) ABS INPUT SIGNAL WIRE # 154 MANUAL LOCKUP
SPEED 149C – T15 ORANGE 150 – T30 e
30 ENGINE SPEED – LO GPI 14 or 52 11
155 – V11 GREEN D
(–) OUTPUT WIRE # 105
A
SENSOR 141 –T14 a
14 ENGINE SPEED – HI GPI 5 12
153 – V12 YELLOW E
(–) OUTPUT WIRE # 167
TWO SPEED AXLE
OUTPUT SPEED
INDICATOR
148 – T32 k 118 – V13 BLUE V INDICATOR
OUTPUT SPEED – LO GPI 11 or 16 (+) OR RELAY
32 13 SIGNAL GROUND # 161
139 – T16 c 135A – V24 GREEN L
16 OUTPUT SPEED – HI ANALOG GROUND 24 (–) INPUT WIRE # 177 BED HOIST INTERLOCK
140 – T31 h 137 – V29 ORANGE S
31 TURBINE SPEED – LO GPI 17 29 (+) INPUT WIRE # 178 RETARDER ENABLE/
TRANSMISSION 149 – T15 b
TURBINE SPEED – HI ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT (ECU) GPI 53
117 – V30 GREEN R QUICK TO NEUTRAL
15 30 WATER TEMP
YELLOW 195 – T13 R 154 – V27 WHITE M
TRANS ID TRANS ID GPI 29 SENSOR
R 13 27
ORANGE 102A – T1 J 105 – V19 GREEN
SOL F + J 1 SOL POWER (F – G – I) GPO 18 19
SOL F –
WHITE 120 – T4 F
F SOL – SPLITTER LO
SCHEMATIC LEGEND: GPO 5
167 – V5 WHITE
F 4 5
131 – T21 BLUE 131 – T21 H = High Side Driver (switch to power) 161 – V31 YELLOW
SOL G – H 21 G SOL – SPLITTER HI SIGNAL RETURN (GPI) 31
YELLOW 130A – T17 A 177 – V14 TAN HARNESS TERMINALS OUTPUT VEHICLE
SOL A + A 17 SOL POWER (B – A) = Low Side Driver (switch to ground) GPI 51 14 VIM TERMINALS INTERFACE HARNESS
WHITE 104 – T7 B 178 – V28 ORANGE
SOL A – B 7 A SOL – LOCK IN RANGE GPI = General Purpose Input GPI 25 or 34 (+) 28
SOL B – GREEN 103 – T5 K 179 – V9 BLUE B1 313 CM REVERSE WARNING
D 5 B SOL – REVERSE GPO = General Purpose Output ENGINE WATER TEMP 9
SOL C +
YELLOW 116A – T19 I
SOL POWER (E – D – C) PSS = Primary Shift Selector REVERSE WARNING
113 – V4 WHITE A1 313 NO RELAY (REQUIRED)
E 19 4 F2 S2
PINK 101 – T24 r SSS = Secondary Shift Selector 123 – V6 TAN G1 323 CM NEUTRAL START
SOL C – P 24 C SOL – LO RANGE NEUTRAL START (+) 6
SOL D –
WHITE 127 – T23 m
D SOL – INTER RANGE
SCI = Serial Communication Interface GPO 7 or 32 (+)
112 – V22 TAN D1 P1 F1 323 NO RELAY (REQUIRED)
M 23 22
TAN 129 – T6 P 132 – V3 ORANGE F2 312 CM RELAY OUTPUT
SOL E – K 6 E SOL – HI RANGE GPO 1 3
SOL D +
YELLOW 135A – T25 g
ANALOG GROUND GPO 4
114 – V2 WHITE D2 P2 C2 312 NC WIRE #112
N 25 2 OVERSPEED INDIC/
YELLOW 156 – T10 W 146 – V26 YELLOW F3 312 NO MAN MODE INDIC
SOL E + L 10 TPS SENSOR INPUT IGNITION SENSE 26 B1 M1
ORANGE 124 – T9 T 125 – V18 WHITE E2 332 CM RELAY OUTPUT
SOL G + G 9 TPS POWER GPO 9 18
SOL B +
YELLOW 147 – T27 d
SUMP TEMP INPUT VEHICLE SPEED
157 – V20 TAN F3 S3 D2 332 NC WIRE #132
C 27 20 LOCKUP
121 – T2 E 143 – V17 GRAY E3 332 NO INDICATOR
FUTURE USE S 2 K SOL – HI (L/U) 17
128 – T20 M BATTERY GROUND 143 – V32 GRAY F1 S1 C1 346 IGNITION POWER
20 K SOL – LO (L/U) 32
111 – T8 X 136 – V1 PINK 10A H2 357UF OPTIONAL SPEED SIG
8 I SOL – LO 1
107 – T3 C BATTERY POWER 136 – V16 PINK C2 N2
A2 314 CM RELAY OUTPUT

SHIFT SELECTOR MODE INPUT


3 J SOL or H SOL – HI 16
110 – T22 D 156 – V10 BLUE B2 314 NC WIRE #114

SHIFT SELECTOR DISPLAY


22 J SOL or H SOL – LO TPS SENSOR INPUT 10 B2 M2 RANGE COMMAND

J 1939 CONTROLLER, LO
J 1939 CONTROLLER, HI
135A – T25 GREEN 124 – V8 PINK A3 314 NO INDICATOR
THROTTLE A 28 RET TEMP SENSOR INPUT (REF) TPS POWER 8
156 – T10 BLUE A1 L1 E1 325 CM RELAY OUTPUT
POSITION B 29 SPEED SHIELD DRAIN (REF) 25

ANALOG GROUND
WIRE #125

BATTERY POWER
SENSOR POWER
IGNITION SENSE

SIGNAL RETURN
VEHICLE SPEED
124 – T9 PINK D1 325 NC RET INDICATOR
SENSOR

CHECK TRANS
C C3 PRESSURE SWITCH (REF) 7

J 1939 SHIELD
12

GREEN
A2 L2

PSS PARITY

SSS PARITY
GPO 6 or 31
RET MODULATION (REF) 15 K1
11

GPI 1 or 9
ISO 9141
GPO 16
K2

SCI LO
GPI 50

GPI 54

SCI HI
OIL LEVEL SENSOR INPUT (REF)

PSS 1
PSS 2
PSS 4
PSS 8

SSS 1
SSS 2
SSS 4
SSS 8
26 21

GPI 8
E1 R1

135D – V24
23 10A J1
18
SUMP OIL D
147 – T27 TAN
ECU E2 R2 J2 + —
TEMP SENSOR C
135B – T25 GREEN CONNECTOR 12/24 VOLT

11
27

18
26
28
31
30

17

32
15
13
29
12
19
20

14
10

16
21
22
23
24
25
“S” BATTERY

5
6
7
8
9

3
121 – T2 TAN PACKARD CONNECTOR
LOCKUP
A (BLACK) VEHICLE INTERFACE
128 – T20 ORANGE DEUTSCH CONNECTOR
SOLENOID K B MODULE (VIM)
146J – S4 YELLOW A B C
H C

119 – S11
163 – S27

166 – S18
169 – S26
126 – S28
115 – S31
157 – S30

151 – S17

143 – S32
176 – S15
183 – S13
184 – S29
182 – S12

180 – S14
175 – S10

136 – S16
190 – S21
191 – S22
192 – S23
193 – S24
194 – S25
151 – S17 BLUE

159 – S2

146 – S4

142 – S1

170 – S5
171 – S6
172 – S7
173 – S8
174 – S9

124 – S3
DIAGNOSTIC K B
THROTTLE
8610, & 9810 LOCK- TOOL J A
142 – S1 WHITE
TO-RANGE MODELS D
102C – T1 ORANGE
143J – S32 GRAY
POSITION
USE SOLENOID I C
111 – T8 GREEN A E SENSOR

ORANGE

ORANGE

ORANGE
YELLOW

YELLOW

YELLOW

YELLOW

YELLOW
GREEN

GREEN

GREEN

GREEN

GREEN
BLACK
WHITE
GRAY
BLUE

BLUE

BLUE

BLUE

BLUE

BLUE
PINK
PINK
RED
TAN
TAN

TAN

TAN

TAN
(OPTIONAL)
107 – T3 GREEN
5610, 6610, & 9610 A
INPUT VEHICLE VEHICLE INTERFACE
110 – T22 WHITE WIRING CONNECTOR
MODELS B
INTERFACE HARNESS (VIW-S)
USE SOLENOID J
WIRE NO. 12V SYSTEM 24V SYSTEM 188H WHITE
V TAN 194 – S25
8610, & 9610 MODELS SHIFT SELECTOR SHIFT SELECTOR 187H RED E
188 BACKLIGHTING,GND BACKLIGHTING,GND U
USE SOLENOID H YELLOW 193 – S24

SECONDARY SHIFT SELECTOR (OPTIONAL)


SHIFT SELECTOR D
187 NOT USED BLUE 192 – S23
BACKLIGHTING,FEED 186H BLUE C
OUTPUT FROM T GREEN 191 – S22
186 CHASSIS GROUND B
12V DIMMER
ORANGE 190 – S21
SWITCHED (+) INPUT 119 – S11 YELLOW A
M
POWER WIRE #119 K

136F – S16
H

S
L
(–) INPUT 163 – S27 BLUE J
R

124F – S3
C
A
B
WIRE #163 W

175F – S10
CHECK 115 – S31 GREEN J 1939 H
B

180F – S14
TRANS INTERFACE G
SPEEDOMETER

B
A
SWITCHED 157 – S30 TAN F
POWER D PINK 136K – S16
R
SCI
PINK 124K – S3
IGNITION 146H – S4 YELLOW N
E GREEN 175K – S10
10A M
BLUE 180K – S14
SWITCHED INDICATOR ( ) OUTPUT 166 – S18 TAN S
OR RELAY N 143F – S32 GRAY 143K – S32
POWER WIRE #166 P
176F – S15 ORANGE 176K – S15
159 – S2 TAN L
ISO 9141 COMMUNICATION A WHITE 188K
DEUTSCH CONNECTOR

188F
V
DEUTSCH RED 187K

187F
(–) INPUT 169 – S26 BLUE CONNECTOR U

186F
S BLUE 186K
WIRE #169 T
146J – S4
SIGNAL RETURN 143H – S32 GRAY C E
P 151 – S17
B B
142 – S1 DDU

W
M

G
U

C
D

N
R

H
V
P

A
B

E
S

K
T

F
L

J
SWITCHED INDICATOR ( ) OUTPUT 176H – S15 ORANGE A F
OR RELAY L 143J – S32
POWER WIRE #176 E D
PRIMARY SHIFT SELECTOR
(–) INPUT 126 – S28 YELLOW V06666
C
WIRE #126 SHIFTER HARNESS (OPTIONAL)

Figure G–1. CEC2 Wiring Schematic

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. G–1/G–2


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

ENGINE
SPEED
SENSOR
B
A
150 T30
141 T14
ORANGE
TAN ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC VEHICLE INTERFACE
WIRING CONNECTOR
(VIW-V)
INPUT VEHICLE INTERFACE HARNESS

OUTPUT
SPEED B
A
148 T32
139 T16
GREEN
YELLOW
BULKHEAD
5/6/8/9000 CEC2
ECU “T” ECU “T”
A
B
C
INPUT WIRE #155
INPUT WIRE #153
INPUT WIRE #118
MANUAL L/U /PARK BRAKE ENABLE
TWO SPEED AXLE INPUT/ENGINE SPEED/TORQUE CONTROL
STALL CHECK/
SHIFT SELECTOR

J00-J08
SENSOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR CONNECTOR 135G-V24 ANALOG GROUND TRANSITION/SPECIAL FUNCTION OVERRIDE
N
(OPTIONAL) (BLUE) (GRAY) INPUT WIRE #137 NEUTRAL TO RANGE INHIBIT
U
INPUT WIRE #117 DELTA-P HOLD
TURBINE 140C T31 BLUE P
B INPUT SIGNAL WIRE #154 MANUAL LOCKUP
SPEED 149C T15 ORANGE ORANGE 150 T30 155 V11 GREEN D
A e 30 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR LOW GPI 14 OR 52 ( ) 11 OUTPUT WIRE #105 TWO SPEED AXLE/OUTPUT SPEED INDICATOR B
SENSOR TAN 141 T14 153 V12 YELLOW E
a 14 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR HI GPI 5 OR 62 ( ) 12 OUTPUT WIRE #167 INDICATOR OUTPUT SPEED
GREEN 148 T32 118 V13 BLUE V OR RELAY INDICATOR
k 32 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR LOW GPI 11 OR 16 OR 63/64 ( + ) 13 SIGNAL GROUND #161
YELLOW 139 T16 135A V24 GREEN L
c 16 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR HI ANALOG GROUND 24 INPUT WIRE #177 BED HOIST INTERLOCK/ABS
BLUE 140 T31 137 V29 ORANGE S
TRANSMISSION ORANGE 149 T15
h 31 TURBINE SPEED SENSOR LO
ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT (ECU) GPI 17 ( ) 29
117 V30 GREEN R
INPUT WIRE #178 RETARDER ENABLE/
QUICK TO NEUTRAL
b 15 TURBINE SPEED SENSOR HI GPI 53 ( ) 30 WATER TEMP (REF)
R 195 T13 YELLOW YELLOW 195 T13 154 V27 WHITE M SENSOR
TRANS ID R 13 TRANS ID GPI 29 ( ) 27
J 102A T1 ORANGE ORANGE 102A T1 105 V19 GREEN
SOL F+ J 1 SOL POWER (F-G-I) GPO 18 OR 34 ( ) 19
SOL F-
F 120 T4 WHITE WHITE 120 T4
F 4 F SOL - SPLITTER LOW SCHEMATIC LEGEND: GPO 5 OR 40 ( ) 5
167 V5 WHITE

SOL G-
H 131 T21 BLUE BLUE 131 T21
H 21 G SOL - SPLITTER HI = High Side Driver (switch to power) SIGNAL RETURN (GPI) 31
161 V31 YELLOW HARNESS TERMINALS OUTPUT VEHICLE
VIM TERMINALS
SOL A+
A 130A T17 YELLOW YELLOW 130A T17
WHITE 104 T7
A 17 SOL POWER (B-A)
= Low Side Driver (switch to ground)
GPI 51 ( ) 14
177 V14 TAN INTERFACE HARNESS
B 104 T7 WHITE 178 V28 ORANGE
SOL A- B 7 A SOL - LOCK IN RANGE GPI 25 OR 34 ( + ) 28
D 103 T5 GREEN GREEN 103 T5 179 V9 BLUE B1 313 CM REVERSE WARNING
SOL B- K 5 B SOL - REVERSE GPI = General Purpose Input ENGINE WATER TEMP (REF) 9
E 116A T19 YELLOW YELLOW 116A T19 113 V4 WHITE A1 313 NO RELAY(REQUIRED)
SOL C+ I 19 SOL POWER (E-D-C) GPO = General Purpose Output REVERSE WARNING ( ) 4 F2 S2
P 101 T24 PINK PINK 101 T24 123 V6 TAN G1 323 CM NEUTRAL START
SOL C- f 24 C SOL - LOW RANGE PSS = Primary Shift Selector NEUTRAL START ( + ) 6
RELAY(REQUIRED)
M 127 T23 WHITE WHITE 127 T23 112 V22 TAN D1 P1 F1 323 NO
SOL D- m 23 D SOL - INTERMEDIATE RANGE SSS = Secondary Shift Selector GPO 7 OR 32 ( + ) 22
K 129 T6 TAN TAN 129 T6 132 V3 ORANGE F2 312 CM RELAY OUTPUT
SOL E- P 6 E SOL - HIGH RANGE SCI = Serial Communication Interface GPO 1 ( ) 3
D2 P2 WIRE #112
N 116B T19 YELLOW GREEN 135A T25 114 V2 WHITE C2 312 NC
SOL D+ g 25 ANALOG GROUND GPO 4 ( ) 2 OVERSPEED INDICATOR/
L 116C T19 YELLOW BLUE 156 T10 146 V26 YELLOW F3 312 NO MANUAL MODE INDICATOR
SOL E+ W 10 TPS SENSOR INPUT IGNITION SENSE 26 B1 M1
G 102B T1 ORANGE PINK 124 T9 125 V18 WHITE E2 332 CM RELAY OUTPUT
SOL G+ T 9 TPS POWER GPO 9 ( ) 18 WIRE #132
C 130B T17 YELLOW TAN 147 T27 157 V20 TAN D2 332 NC
SOL B+ d 27 SUMP TEMP INPUT VEHICLE SPEED 20 F3 S3 LOCKUP
S TAN 121 T2 143 V17 GRAY E3 332 NO INDICATOR
FUTURE USE E 2 SUPPLY TO SOL K (L/U) 17
ORANGE 128 T20 BATTERY GROUND 143 V32 GRAY F1 S1 C1 346 IGNITION POWER
M 20 K SOL LOCKUP 32
GREEN 111 T8 136 V1 PINK 10A H2 357UF OPTIONAL SPEED SIGNAL
X 8 I SOL LIR/LOW 8963 AND 9800 MODEL 1
GREEN 107 T3 BATTERY POWER C2 N2 314 CM
136 V16 PINK A2 RELAY OUTPUT

SHIFT SELECTOR MODE INPUT


C 3 SOL. POWER (J)(T/B) OR H SOLENOID 16 WIRE #114
WHITE 110 T22 156 V10 BLUE B2 314 NC

SHIFT SELECTOR DISPLAY


D 22 J SOL TRIM BOOST OR H SOLENOID TPS SENSOR INPUT 10 B2 M2 RANGE COMMAND

J 1939 CONTROLLER, LO

ANALOG GROUND (REF)


J 1939 CONTROLLER, HI
124 V8 PINK A3 314 NO INDICATOR
28 RETARDER TEMP. SENSOR INPUT (REF) TPS POWER 8 325 CM
A1 L1 E1

VEHICLE SPEED ( )
29 25

BATTERY POWER
SPEED SHIELD DRAIN (REF)

SENSOR POWER
325 NC

CHECK TRANS( )

IGNITION SENSE

SIGNAL RETURN
GPI 54 OR 63/64
D1

J 1939 SHIELD
12 C3 PRESSURE SWITCH (REF) 7

GPI 58 OR 55
343

GPO 6 OR 31

PSS PARITY

SSS PARITY
A2 L2

135D V24 GREEN


K1

GPI 1 OR 9
11 RETARDER MODULATION (REF) 15

ISO 9141
GPO 16
K2

SCI LO
SCI HI
26

PSS 1
PSS 2
PSS 4
PSS 8

SSS 1
SSS 2
SSS 4
SSS 8
OIL LEVEL SENSOR INPUT (REF) 21

GPI 8
E1 R1 336
18 23 J1
E2 R2 10A J2 + —
12/24 VOLT

11
27

18
26
28
31
30

17

32
15
13
29
12
19
20

14
10

16
21
22
23
24
25
BATTERY

5
6
7
8
9

3
PACKARD CONNECTOR
DEUTSCH CONNECTOR VEHICLE INTERFACE
THROTTLE A
135A T25 GREEN
156 T10 BLUE 146J S4 YELLOW ECU A B C
MODULE (VIM)
B H C
POSITION 124 T9 PINK DIAGNOSTIC K B
151 S17 BLUE CONNECTOR
C “S” THROTTLE RELAY OUTPUT
SENSOR TOOL J A
142 S1 WHITE
(BLACK) POSITION
WIRE #125
143J S32 GRAY RETARDER INDICATOR

180 S14
175 S10

136 S16
ORANGE 190 S21
191 S22
192 S23
YELLOW 193 S24
194 S25
YELLOW 119 S11
163 S27

166 S18
169 S26
YELLOW 126 S28
115 S31
157 S30

151 S17

143 S32
ORANGE 176 S15
183 S13
184 S29
182 S12

ORANGE 170 S5
171 S6
172 S7
YELLOW 173 S8
174 S9

124 S3
159 S2

YELLOW 146 S4

142 S1
A E SENSOR
(OPTIONAL)
SWITCHED
INPUT VEHICLE VEHICLE INTERFACE
WIRING CONNECTOR POWER 10A

GREEN

GREEN

GREEN
GREEN

GREEN
BLACK
WHITE
INTERFACE HARNESS

GRAY
(VIW-S)

BLUE

BLUE

BLUE
BLUE

BLUE

BLUE

PINK
PINK
RED

TAN

TAN
TAN
TAN

TAN
SUMP OIL D
147 T27 TAN
WIRE NO 12V SYSTEM 24V SYSTEM
TEMP SENSOR C
135B T25 GREEN SHIFT SELECTOR SHIFT SELECTOR 188H WHITE
188 BACKLIGHTING,GRD BACKLIGHTING,GRD V
121 T2 TAN TAN 194 S25
A SHIFT SELECTOR 187H RED E
LOCKUP 128 T20 ORANGE 187 BACKLIGHTING,FEED NOT USED U YELLOW 193 S24

SECONDARY SHIFT SELECTOR (OPTIONAL)


B D
SOLENOID K 186 CHASSIS GROUND
OUTPUT FROM
12V DIMMER 186H BLUE
BLUE 192 S23
C
T GREEN 191 S22
SWITCHED INPUT B
POWER WIRE #119 ORANGE 190 S21
119 S11 YELLOW A
M
8610, & 9810 LOCK- INPUT

S
WIRE #163

L
TO-RANGE MODELS D
102C T1 ORANGE
R
163 S27 BLUE

C
A
B
USE SOLENOID I 111 T8 GREEN CHECK
C TRANS

136F S16
115 S31 GREEN J 1939
B INTERFACE

124F S3
107 T3 GREEN SPEEDOMETER

B
A
A
5610, 6610, & 9610

175F S10
SWITCHED 157 S30 TAN
110 T22 WHITE POWER D PINK 136K S16
B

180F S14
R
MODELS SCI PINK 124K S3
IGNITION 146H S4 YELLOW N
USE SOLENOID J 10A
E GREEN 175K S10
M
BLUE 180K S14
SWITCHED INDICATOR OUTPUT 166 S18 TAN S
8610, & 9610 MODELS POWER OR RELAY WIRE #166 N 143F S32 GRAY 143K S32
P
USE SOLENOID H ISO 9141 COMMUNICATION 159 S2 TAN
176F S15 ORANGE 176K S15
L
A WHITE 188K

188F
V
RED 187K

187F
INPUT 169 S26 BLUE U
S BLUE 186K
WIRE #169 T

186F
SIGNAL RETURN 143H S32 GRAY
P

SWITCHED INDICATOR OUTPUT 176H S15 ORANGE

W
M

G
U

C
D

N
R

H
V
P

A
B

E
S

K
T

F
L

J
OR RELAY L
POWER WIRE #176
INPUT
C
126 S28 YELLOW PRIMARY SHIFT SELECTOR
WIRE #126
143J

146J
S32

S17
142

151
S1

S4

E A B C
DEUTSCH
DEUTSCH CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR
B

D DDU
E
F

V09979.00.00
SHIFTER HARNESSS (OPTIONAL)

Figure G–2. CEC2 Wiring Schematic-With VIM

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. G–3/G–4


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

ECU INTERFACE SCHEMATIC


ENGINE 150 T30 ORANGE
B VEHICLE INTERFACE
SPEED
SENSOR A
141 T14 TAN WIRING CONNECTOR
(VIW-V)
INPUT VEHICLE INTERFACE HARNESS

5/6/8/9000 CEC2
INPUT WIRE #155 MANUAL L/U / PARK BRAKE ENABLE
A
INPUT WIRE #153 TWO SPEED AXLE INPUT OR ENGINE SPEED/TORQUE CONTROL
OUTPUT 148 T32 GREEN B
B
SPEED 139 T16 YELLOW C
INPUT WIRE #118 STALL CHECK/SHIFT SELECTOR TRANSITION/
SENSOR A BULKHEAD ECU “T” ANALOG GROUND SPECIAL FUNCTION OVERRIDE
CONNECTOR CONNECTOR ECU “T” 135G-V24

J00-J08 CONNECTOR N
(OPTIONAL) (BLUE) INPUT WIRE #137 NEUTRAL TO RANGE INHIBIT
(GRAY) U
INPUT WIRE #117 DELTA-P HOLD
TURBINE 140C T31 BLUE P
B INPUT SIGNAL WIRE #154 MANUAL LOCKUP
SPEED 149C T15 ORANGE ORANGE 150 T30 e 155 V11 GREEN D
A 30 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR LOW GPI 14 OR 52 ( ) 11 OUTPUT WIRE #105
SENSOR TAN 141 T14 153 V12 YELLOW E TWO SPEED AXLE/OUTPUT SPEED INDICATOR B
a 14 ENGINE SPEED SENSOR HI GPI 5 OR 62 ( ) 12 OUTPUT WIRE #167 INDICATOR
GREEN 148 T32 118 V13 BLUE V OUTPUT SPEED INDICATOR
k 32 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR LOW GPI 11 OR 16 OR 63/64 ( + ) 13 SIGNAL GROUND #161 OR RELAY
YELLOW 139 T16 135A V24 GREEN L
c 16 OUTPUT SPEED SENSOR HI ANALOG GROUND 24 INPUT WIRE #177 BED HOIST INTERLOCK/ABS
BLUE 140 T31 137 V29 ORANGE S
TRANSMISSION ORANGE 149 T15
h 31 TURBINE SPEED SENSOR LO ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT (ECU) GPI 17 ( ) 29
117 V30 GREEN R
INPUT WIRE #178
RETARDER ENABLE/QUICK TO NEUTRAL
b 15 TURBINE SPEED SENSOR HI GPI 53 ( ) 30
M WATER TEMP (REF)
R 195 T13 YELLOW YELLOW 195 T13 R 154 V27 WHITE SENSOR
TRANS ID 13 TRANS ID GPI 29 ( ) 27
J 102A T1 ORANGE ORANGE 102A T1 J 105 V19 GREEN
SOL F+ 1 SOL POWER (F-G-I) GPO 18 OR 34 ( ) 19
SOL F-
F 120 T4 WHITE WHITE 120 T4 F 4 F SOL - SPLITTER LOW
SCHEMATIC LEGEND: GPO 5 OR 40 ( ) 5
167 V5 WHITE
H 131 T21 BLUE BLUE 131 T21 161 V31 YELLOW
SOL G- H 21 G SOL - SPLITTER HI = High Side Driver (switch to power) SIGNAL RETURN (GPI) 31
A 130A T17 YELLOW YELLOW 130A T17 177 V14 TAN OUTPUT IS TURNED ON
SOL A+ A 17 SOL POWER (B-A) GPI 51 ( ) 14 WHEN REVERSE RANGE
B 104 T7 WHITE WHITE 104 T7 B
= Low Side Driver (switch to ground) 178 V28 ORANGE IS ATTAINED
SOL A- 7 A SOL - LOCK IN RANGE GPI 25 OR 34 ( + ) 28
D 103 T5 GREEN GREEN 103 T5 179 V9 BLUE
SOL B- K 5 B SOL - REVERSE GPI = General Purpose Input ENGINE WATER TEMP (REF) 9 REVERSE WARNING (REQUIRED)
E 116A T19 YELLOW YELLOW 116A T19 113 V4 WHITE
SOL C+ I 19 SOL POWER (E-D-C) GPO = General Purpose Output REVERSE WARNING ( ) 4
P 101 T24 PINK PINK 101 T24 123 V6 TAN WIRE #113
SOL C- f 24 C SOL - LOW RANGE PSS = Primary Shift Selector NEUTRAL START ( + ) 6 INDICATOR
M 127 T23 WHITE WHITE 127 T23 112 V22 TAN OR RELAY
SOL D- m 23 D SOL - INTERMEDIATE RANGE SSS = Secondary Shift Selector GPO 7 OR 32 ( + ) 22
K 129 T6 TAN TAN 129 T6 132 V3 ORANGE
SOL E- P 6 E SOL - HIGH RANGE SCI = Serial Communication Interface GPO 1 ( ) 3
N 116B T19 YELLOW GREEN 135A T25 114 V2 WHITE
SOL D+ g 25 ANALOG GROUND GPO 4 ( ) 2
L 116C T19 YELLOW BLUE 156 T10 146 V26 YELLOW
SOL E+ W 10 TPS SENSOR INPUT IGNITION SENSE 26 OUTPUT IS TURNED ON
G 102B T1 ORANGE PINK 124 T9 125 V18 WHITE
SOL G+ T 9 TPS POWER GPO 9 ( ) 18 WHEN REVERSE RANGE
C 130B T17 YELLOW TAN 147 T27 157 V20 TAN IS ATTAINED
SOL B+ d 27 SUMP TEMP INPUT VEHICLE SPEED 20
S TAN 121 T2 143 V17 GRAY
FUTURE USE E 2 SUPPLY TO SOL K (L/U) 17 REVERSE WARNING (REQUIRED)
ORANGE 128 T20 BATTERY GROUND 143 V32 GRAY
M 20 K SOL LOCKUP 32
GREEN 111 T8 136 V1 PINK WIRE #123 INDICATOR
X 8 I SOL LIR/LOW 8963 AND 9800 MODEL 1 OR RELAY
GREEN 107 T3 BATTERY POWER 136 V16 PINK

SHIFT SELECTOR MODE INPUT


C 3 SOL. POWER (J)(T/B) OR H SOLENOID 16
WHITE 110 T22 156 V10 BLUE

SHIFT SELECTOR DISPLAY


D 22 J SOL TRIM BOOST OR H SOLENOID TPS SENSOR INPUT 10

J 1939 CONTROLLER, LO

ANALOG GROUND (REF)


J 1939 CONTROLLER, HI
124 V8 PINK
28 RETARDER TEMP. SENSOR INPUT (REF) TPS POWER 8

)
)
29 25 OUTPUT IS TURNED ON

BATTERY POWER
SPEED SHIELD DRAIN (REF)

VEHICLE SPEED (

SENSOR POWER
IGNITION SENSE

SIGNAL RETURN
CHECK TRANS (
GPI 54 OR 63/64
WHEN REVERSE RANGE

135D V24 GREEN


J 1939 SHIELD
12 C3 PRESSURE SWITCH (REF) 7 IS ATTAINED

GPI 55 OR 58

GPO 6 OR 31

PSS PARITY

SSS PARITY
GPI 1 OR 9
11 RETARDER MODULATION (REF) 15

ISO 9141
GPO 16
REVERSE WARNING (REQUIRED)

SCI LO
SCI HI

PSS 1
PSS 2
PSS 4
PSS 8

SSS 1
SSS 2
SSS 4
SSS 8
26 OIL LEVEL SENSOR INPUT (REF) 21

GPI 8
18 23 WIRE #112 INDICATOR
OR RELAY

11
27

18
26
28
31
30

17

32
15
13
29
12
19
20

14
10

16
21
22
23
24
25
2

5
6
7
8
9

3
PACKARD CONNECTOR
DEUTSCH CONNECTOR A B C WIRE #136
135A T25 GREEN
THROTTLE A
156 T10 BLUE H C
146J S4 YELLOW ECU THROTTLE 10A OUTPUT IS TURNED ON
B WHEN REVERSE RANGE
POSITION 124 T9 PINK DIAGNOSTIC K B
151 S17 BLUE CONNECTOR POSITION ECU GROUND IS ATTAINED
C “S”
SENSOR TOOL J A
142 S1 WHITE
(BLACK)
SENSOR WIRE #143
REVERSE WARNING (REQUIRED)
143J S32 GRAY
A E (OPTIONAL)

180 S14
175 S10

136 S16
ORANGE 190 S21
191 S22
192 S23
YELLOW 193 S24
194 S25
YELLOW 119 S11
163 S27

166 S18
169 S26
YELLOW 126 S28
115 S31
157 S30

151 S17

143 S32
ORANGE 176 S15
183 S13
184 S29
182 S12

ORANGE 170 S5
171 S6
172 S7
YELLOW 173 S8
174 S9

124 S3
159 S2

YELLOW 146 S4

142 S1
WIRE #132 INDICATOR
WIRING SHALL BE SIZED TO MAINTAIN A MINIMUM OR RELAY
INPUT VEHICLE VEHICLE INTERFACE
WIRING CONNECTOR OF 10.5 VOLTS AT THE ECU DURING MAX
+ –

GREEN

GREEN

GREEN
GREEN

GREEN
12/24 VOLT

BLACK
WHITE
INTERFACE HARNESS CURRENT DRAW CONDITIONS (9 AMPS)

GRAY
(VIW-S)

BLUE

BLUE

BLUE
BLUE

BLUE

BLUE

PINK
PINK
BATTERY

RED

TAN

TAN
TAN
TAN

TAN
SUMP OIL D
147 T27 TAN
WIRE NO 12V SYSTEM 24V SYSTEM
TEMP SENSOR C
135B T25 GREEN SHIFT SELECTOR SHIFT SELECTOR 188H WHITE OUTPUT IS TURNED ON
188 BACKLIGHTING,GRD BACKLIGHTING,GRD V TAN 194 S25 WHEN REVERSE RANGE
121 T2 TAN
A SHIFT SELECTOR 187H RED E IS ATTAINED
LOCKUP B
128 T20 ORANGE 187 BACKLIGHTING,FEED NOT USED U YELLOW 193 S24
D
SOLENOID K 186 CHASSIS GROUND
OUTPUT FROM
12V DIMMER 186H BLUE
BLUE 192 S23
C
REVERSE WARNING (REQUIRED)
T GREEN 191 S22
INPUT B WIRE #114 INDICATOR
SWITCHED ORANGE 190 S21

SECONDARY SHIFT SELECTOR


WIRE #119 A OR RELAY
POWER 119 S11 YELLOW
8610, & 9810 LOCK- INPUT
M

TO-RANGE MODELS 102C T1 ORANGE

S
L
D WIRE #163
163 S27 BLUE WIRE #146 SWITCHED
R
USE SOLENOID I 111 T8 GREEN

C
A
B
C CHECK POWER
TRANS 10A

136F S16
115 S31 GREEN J 1939
B INTERFACE

124F S3
107 T3 GREEN OUTPUT IS TURNED ON
A
5610, 6610, & 9610 SPEEDOMETER

A
B
WHEN REVERSE RANGE

175F S10
110 T22 WHITE SWITCHED 157 S30 TAN
B D PINK 136K S16 IS ATTAINED
MODELS POWER

180F S14
R
SCI PINK 124K S3
USE SOLENOID J IGNITION 146H S4 YELLOW N REVERSE WARNING (REQUIRED)
E GREEN 175K S10
10A M
BLUE 180K S14 WIRE #125 INDICATOR
8610, & 9610 MODELS SWITCHED INDICATOR OUTPUT
N
166 S18 TAN
GRAY 143K S32
S OR RELAY
POWER OR RELAY WIRE #166 143F S32
USE SOLENOID H 176F S15 ORANGE 176K S15
P
159 S2 TAN L
ISO 9141 COMMUNICATION A WHITE 188K WIRE #157 OPTIONAL SPEED SIGNAL
V

188F
RED 187K ALSO SEE VIW-S

187F
INPUT 169 S26 BLUE U
S BLUE 186K
WIRE #169 T

186F
SIGNAL RETURN 143H S32 GRAY
P

SWITCHED INDICATOR OUTPUT 176H S15 ORANGE

W
M

G
U

C
D

N
R

H
V
P

A
B

E
S

K
T

F
L

J
POWER OR RELAY WIRE #176
INPUT
C
126 S28 YELLOW PRIMARY SHIFT SELECTOR
WIRE #126
143J

146J
S32

S17
142

151
S1

S4

E A B C
DEUTSCH
DEUTSCH CONNECTOR
CONNECTOR
B

D DDU
E
F

V09980.00.00
SHIFTER HARNESSS (OPTIONAL)

Figure G–3. CEC2 Wiring Schematic-Without VIM


Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. G–5/G–6
COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

ECU
LIR LTN
T MAIN 5610 5610
6610 6610 LIR LTN LIR LTN
BLUE BODY SOLENOID 9610 9610 8610 8610 9810 9805, 9810
7 B Range Not Range Not Range Not
17 A A Lock Used Lock Used Lock Used
C REVERSE/ Rev 1 Rev 1 Rev 1 Rev 1 Lock Lock
5 D B SHIFT LOCK Rev 2 Rev 2 Shift Shift
24 P LOW 1st 1st 2nd 2nd 3rd 3rd
19 E C RANGE 2nd 2nd 5th 5th
N INTER 3rd 3rd 3rd 3rd 4th inter 4th inter
23 M D RANGE 4th 4th 4th 4th 6th high 6th high
13 R

L HIGH 5th 5th 5th 5th 7th 7th


6 K E RANGE 6th 6th 6th 6th 8th 8th
4 F SPLITTER Rev 1 Rev 1 Rev 1 Rev 1
1 J F LOW 1–3–5 1–3–5 1–2–3–5 1–2–3–5 1–3–4–7 1–3–4–7
G SPLITTER Rev 2 Not Not Not
21 H G HIGH 2–4–6 Used 4–6 Used 2–5–6–8 Used
S
TRIM BOOST
3 A J Sol J Sol H Sol H Sol H Sol H Sol
22 B J/H Trim Boost Trim Boost 1st 1st 1st/2nd 1st/2nd
8 C Not Not Range Not Range Not
D I
Used Used Lock Used Lock Used
E
LOCKUP BODY
2 A
20 B K Lockup Lockup Lockup Lockup Lockup Lockup
27 D TEMP
C SENSOR

LEGEND: LIR = Lock-in-Range


25 A
10 B LTN = Lock-to-Neutral
TPS
9 C TPS = Throttle Position Sensor
SS = Speed Sensor
14 A
30 B SS – ENGINE

15 A
31 B SS – TURBINE

16 A
32 B SS – OUTPUT
V06647.01.01

Figure G–4. CEC2 Solenoid Function By Model

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. G–7/G–8


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

OFF HIGHWAY ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT SCHEMATIC


5610/6610/9610
VIGN
S4 NO CONNECT: T18
IGNITION
DIGITAL V7
V26 INTERFACE V15
BAT V1
V21
V16 VCC V23
POWER VREF
V17 SUPPLY
VBAT
V32
SAE + S13
+ — V25 DIAGNOSTIC
J1939
12/24V — S29 TOOL
(CAN)
PRIMARY MICROPROCESSOR
D,A,P SELECTOR CAN
SELECT

S5 68HC16 SHEILD
SS 1
S6 No /2 SPEEDOMETER
R MODE
ELECT. SS 2 S30
S7 or
N SS 4
SWITCH No /4 V20
D S8 SS 8 MEMORY
MATRIX 256K FLASH
S9 SS P
S10 32K RAM
MODE ISO S2 DIAGNOSTIC
12V S16 9141 TOOL
DIM S14
DISPLAY DATA
S3 CAN CONTROLLER
VREF
S32
SAE/ATA + S1 DIAGNOSTIC
P DRIVER TOOL ENGINE
(J1708) — S17 INTERFACE

ELECT. CHECK –V
SECONDARY TRANSMISSION IGN
SWITCH SELECTOR CT S31
MATRIX S21
SS 1
24V S22 REV WARNING
DIM SS 2 RW V4
S23
SS 4
S24 OUT 1 V2
SS 8
S25
SS P OUT 2 V3
MODE

RET OUT 4 V18


MOD-S S20
S19 OUT 5 V19
VIGN A
V13 IN 3 OUT 6 S15
S11 IN 4
V28 OUT 7 S18
IN 11
V11 IN 1 OUT 8 V5
V12 IN 2 VBAT
DIGITAL
V27 IN 5 INTERFACE
S27 IN 6
V29 OUT 3 V22
IN 7
V30 IN 8
S28 NS V6 NEUTRAL START
IN 9
V14 IN 10
S26 A HI T1
IN 12
V31 SHORT GROUND
D SPLITTER
DETECT A T4 F LOW
V8 VREF
D T21 G SPLITTER
THROTTLE-V V10 HIGH
VBAT
ENGINE H20 V9 OPEN
J T8
V24 A A HI T2
THROTTLE-T T10
T9 ANALOG B T20 K LOCKUP
VREF INTERFACE
A HI T17
OIL T26
LEVEL (REF)
C T5 B REVERSE
SUMP T27
TEMP LOCK IN
G T7 A RANGE
T11
RET T28 F HI T3
PUMP (REF)
TRIM
T25 A F T22 J BOOST
C3 T12 DIGITAL
PRESSURE (REF) EHN HI T19
INTERFACE
T14 + HIGH
INPUT (ENGINE) E T6 E RANGE
T30 — NE
SPEED
INTER
H T23 D RANGE
T15 +
TURBINE NT LOW
SPEED T31 — N T24 C RANGE
T16 +
OUTPUT P OPTIONAL
T32 — NO TRANS ID T13
SPEED SOLENOID
T29 A CONNECTION
= Optional Connection
V06667
Not used in Lock-To-Neutral models

Figure G–5. ECU Schematic—5610, 6610, 9610

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. G–9


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC 2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

OFF HIGHWAY ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT SCHEMATIC


8610
VIGN
S4 FUTURE USE: T18
IGNITION
DIGITAL V7
V26 INTERFACE V15
BAT V1
V21
V16 VCC V23
POWER VREF
V17 SUPPLY
VBAT
V32
SAE + S13
+ — V25 DIAGNOSTIC
J1939
12/24V — S29 TOOL
(CAN)
PRIMARY MICROPROCESSOR
D,A,P SELECTOR CAN
SELECT

S5 68HC16 SHEILD
SS 1
S6 No /2 SPEEDOMETER
R MODE
ELECT. SS 2 S30
S7 or
N SS 4
SWITCH No /4 V20
D S8 SS 8 MEMORY
MATRIX 256K FLASH
S9 SS P
S10 32K RAM
MODE ISO S2 DIAGNOSTIC
12V S16 9141 TOOL
DIM S14
DISPLAY DATA
S3 CAN CONTROLLER
VREF
S32
SAE/ATA + S1 DIAGNOSTIC
P DRIVER TOOL ENGINE
(J1708) — S17 INTERFACE

ELECT. CHECK –V
SECONDARY TRANSMISSION IGN
SWITCH SELECTOR CT S31
MATRIX S21
SS 1
24V S22 REV WARNING
DIM SS 2 RW V4
S23
SS 4
S24 OUT 1 V2
SS 8
S25
SS P OUT 2 V3
MODE

RET OUT 4 V18


MOD-S S20
S19 OUT 5 V19
VIGN A
V13 IN 3 OUT 6 S15
S11 IN 4
V28 OUT 7 S18
IN 11
V11 IN 1 OUT 8 V5
V12 IN 2 VBAT
DIGITAL
V27 IN 5 INTERFACE
S27 IN 6
V29 OUT 3 V22
IN 7
V30 IN 8
S28 NS V6 NEUTRAL START
IN 9
V14 IN 10
S26 A HI T1
IN 12
V31 SHORT GROUND
D SPLITTER
DETECT A T4 F LOW
V8 VREF
D T21 G SPLITTER
THROTTLE-V V10 HIGH
VBAT
ENGINE H20 V9 LOCK IN
J T8 I
V24 A RANGE
A HI T2
THROTTLE-T T10
T9 ANALOG B T20 K LOCKUP
VREF INTERFACE
A HI T17
OIL T26
LEVEL (REF)
C T5 B REVERSE
SUMP T27
TEMP LOCK IN
G T7 A RANGE
T11
RET T28 F HI T3
TEMP (REF)
LOW
T25 A F T22 H RANGE
C3 T12 DIGITAL
PRESSURE (REF) EHN HI T19
INTERFACE
T14 + 2nd
INPUT (ENGINE) E T6 E RANGE
T30 — NE
SPEED
3rd - 4th
H T23 D
T15 + RANGE
TURBINE NT 5th - 6th
SPEED T31 — N T24 C
RANGE
T16 +
OUTPUT P OPTIONAL
T32 — NO TRANS ID T13
SPEED SOLENOID
T29 A CONNECTION
= Optional Connection
V06668
Not used in Lock-To-Neutral models

Figure G–6. ECU Schematic—8610

G–10 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

OFF HIGHWAY ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNIT SCHEMATIC


9805, 9810
VIGN
S4 FUTURE USE: T18
IGNITION
DIGITAL V7
V26 INTERFACE V15
BAT V1
V21
V16 VCC V23
POWER VREF
V17 SUPPLY
VBAT
V32
SAE + S13
+ — V25 DIAGNOSTIC
J1939
12/24V — S29 TOOL
(CAN)
PRIMARY MICROPROCESSOR
D,A,P SELECTOR CAN
SELECT

S5 68HC16 SHEILD
SS 1
S6 No /2 SPEEDOMETER
R MODE
ELECT. SS 2 S30
S7 or
N SS 4
SWITCH No /4 V20
D S8 SS 8 MEMORY
MATRIX 256K FLASH
S9 SS P
S10 32K RAM
MODE ISO S2 DIAGNOSTIC
12V S16 9141 TOOL
DIM S14
DISPLAY DATA
S3 CAN CONTROLLER
VREF
S32
SAE/ATA + S1 DIAGNOSTIC
P DRIVER TOOL ENGINE
(J1708) — S17 INTERFACE

ELECT. CHECK –V
SECONDARY TRANSMISSION IGN
SWITCH SELECTOR CT S31
MATRIX S21
SS 1
24V S22 REV WARNING
DIM SS 2 RW V4
S23
SS 4
S24 OUT 1 V2
SS 8
S25
SS P OUT 2 V3
MODE

RET OUT 4 V18


MOD-S S20
S19 OUT 5 V19
VIGN A
V13 IN 3 OUT 6 S15
S11 IN 4
V28 OUT 7 S18
IN 11
V11 IN 1 OUT 8 V5
V12 IN 2 VBAT
DIGITAL
V27 IN 5 INTERFACE
S27 IN 6
V29 OUT 3 V22
IN 7
V30 IN 8
S28 NS V6 NEUTRAL START
IN 9
V14 IN 10
S26 A HI T1
IN 12
V31 SHORT GROUND
D SPLITTER
DETECT A T4 F LOW
V8 VREF
D T21 G SPLITTER
THROTTLE-V V10 HIGH
VBAT
ENGINE H20 V9 LOCK IN
J T8 I
V24 A RANGE
A HI T2
THROTTLE-T T10
T9 ANALOG B T20 K LOCKUP
VREF INTERFACE
A HI T17
OIL T26
LEVEL (REF)
C T5 B LOCK
SUMP T27
TEMP LOCK IN
G T7 A RANGE
T11
RET T28 F HI T3
TEMP (REF)
LOW
T25 A F T22 J RANGE
C3 T12 DIGITAL
PRESSURE (REF) EHN HI T19
INTERFACE
T14 + INTER
INPUT (ENGINE) E T6 E RANGE
T30 — NE
SPEED
HI INTER
H T23 D
T15 + RANGE
TURBINE NT HIGH
SPEED T31 — N T24 C
RANGE
T16 +
OUTPUT P OPTIONAL
T32 — NO TRANS ID T13
SPEED SOLENOID
T29 A CONNECTION
= Optional Connection
V06669.00.01
Not used in Lock-To-Neutral models

Figure G–7. ECU Schematic—9805, 9810

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. G–11


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX G—CEC 2 SYSTEM/ECU WIRING SCHEMATICS

NOTES

G–12 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX H—EXTERNALLY-GENERATED ELECTRONIC INTERFERENCE

H–1. ELECTROMAGNETIC/RADIO FREQUENCY INTERFERENCE


All electrical and electronic systems generate electromagnetic fields that can interfere with other electronic
systems. Allison Transmission electronic transmission controls comply with Federal Communications Commission
(FCC) regulations and other guidelines concerning emitted radio frequency interference for transportation
electronics. The position of Allison Transmission is that manufacturers and installers of EMI/RFI emitting
equipment are responsible for adhering to FCC regulations and other guidelines concerning emitted radio
frequency interference for transportation electronics.
Some radio-telephone or two-way communication radios (land-mobile radio), or the manner in which they are
installed, can adversely affect vehicle operation or be affected by other vehicle components. Expenses incurred to
protect vehicle-related systems from EMI/RFI emissions by radio-telephone or two-way communications radios
(land-mobile radio) or to integrate such devices into vehicles are not the responsibility of Allison Transmission.

H–2. GENERAL GUIDELINES FOR RADIO EQUIPMENT INSTALLATION


The following general guidelines for installing radio-telephone or two-way communications radios (land-mobile
radio) in a vehicle supplement, but DO NOT replace, detailed instructions provided by the radio equipment
manufacturer. Detailed installation instructions are the sole responsibility of the radio equipment manufacturer.
Experience has shown that most EMI/RFI problems can be prevented or eliminated by following the guidelines. If
EMI/RFI problems persist after following the guidelines and after ensuring the installation conforms to the
guidelines, contact the vehicle and radio equipment manufacturers for additional installation or equipment
operation instructions.

A. Transmitter Installation
1. Locate remote radio transmitters as far away from other electronic devices and as near to the side
of the vehicle body as possible.
2. Mount transceivers (transmitter and receiver in one box) under the dash so as not to interfere with
vehicle controls or passenger movement.

B. Antenna Installation
Each vehicle and body style react differently to radio frequency energy. When dealing with an
unfamiliar vehicle, test various antenna locations by using a magnetic mount antenna and checking
for adverse effects. Antenna location is a major factor in EMI/RFI problems.

C. Antenna Cable Routing


1. Use high quality, 95 percent shield coverage, coaxial (coax) cable. Route the coax well away from
any electronic components.
2. Route antenna cables as far away from vehicle wiring as possible to reduce the likelihood of the
vehicle wiring acting as an antenna for interference.

D. Radio Wiring and Connector Location


1. Connect transmitter power leads directly to the battery.
2. For transceivers (transmitter and receiver in one box) with ignition control, place a 12V power
contactor at the vehicle battery. Drive the contactor coil, through an appropriate in-line fuse, from
an ignition circuit not powered during engine cranking.
3. Any negative lead from a handset or control unit must return to battery negative.
4. Connect the positive lead from a handset or control unit directly to battery.
5. Fuse handset or control unit positive and negative leads separately from the transceiver negative
and positive leads. Use correctly rated fuses.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. H–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX H—EXTERNALLY-GENERATED ELECTRONIC INTERFERENCE


E. Power and Ground Wire Routing
Route radio power and ground wires as far away as possible from electronic control modules.
F. Troubleshooting
The following are common causes of EMI/RFI problems:
• Power leads connected to points other than the battery
• Improper antenna location
• Poor shielding or connections to antenna cable
• Transmitter or transceiver wiring too close to vehicle electronics

H–3. EXTERNALLY-GENERATED SPEED SENSOR SIGNALS

A. Testing for Externally-Generated Speed Sensor Signals


Use the following procedures to determine if speed sensor signals generated by a source external to
the transmission or wiring harness are present:
1. Turn ignition ON.
2. Keep engine OFF.
3. If the ECU is ON (shift selector display remains illuminated), connect the Allison DOC™ For
PC–Service Tool or Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool.
NOTE: If false speed signals were present at the previous shutdown, the ECU might still be “on” even though
the ignition is “off.” Pro-Link® 9000 is powered by ignition power so the ignition must be “on” to use
the Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool to read the speed signals.
4. Read speed sensor signals.
5. If a speed sensor signal is other than one (1), then there is a short to another circuit that is carrying
an AC signal.
6. Measure the resistance of the sensor.
7. Test for shorts to other circuits within the harness or transmission connector.
8. Test to be sure there is no conductive material inside the connector.
9. Inspect to be sure speed sensor circuit wires are a twisted pair.
10. Test to be sure a properly grounded drain wire.
11. Test for the presence of a strong external AC signal.
12. Repair or replace parts as required.

H–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX J—DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER INFORMATION

J–1. ALLISON DOC FOR PC-SERVICE TOOL


NOTE: Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is the preferred Allison Transmission diagnostic tool.
NOTE: Refer to Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool User Guide, GN3433EN, for the most current information.
Allison DOC™ (Diagnostic Optimized Connection) For PC–Service Tool is a PC-based diagnostic tool for use with
5/6/8/9000 Series Transmissions utilizing CEC2 controls. The Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is a full-feature
diagnostic software application supporting CEC2 control systems. When installed on a PC, it will allow the
technician to acquire data from the transmission’s control system and through the use of embedded troubleshooting
manuals, conduct systematic troubleshooting of transmission complaints.
Basic Features
The Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool uses a Windows® style GUI and includes:
• User selected views of multiple transmission parameters
• View Active and historical diagnostic trouble codes (DTCs)
• Graphical instrument panel view of transmission parameters
• Strip chart function
• User configurable Snapshot function
• User configurable Print function
• Code driven links to embedded CEC2 Troubleshooting Manuals
• Reprogramming capability (available after satisfying Allison Transmission training certification requirements)
• Demo Mode which allows the user to practice the program without being connected to a vehicle
• Animated, screen by screen, help support (found in Help, Video-based training materials, Allison DOC™
For PC–Service Tool Training Videos)
• Application Configuration: This menu function serves as the platform for three different features
1. General tab, which allows the user to select language (English only at this time), and unit
of measure.
2. ECU/TCM Reprogramming tab, used to enable the reprogramming capability of the Allison
DOC™ For PC–Service Tool.
3. Update Application tab, will access a web URL that will contain minor updates for the diagnostic
tool to support changes in the various transmission control systems.
• Data Bus Viewer allows the user to capture (see and save) the raw data transmitted on the various vehicle
data buses supported by Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool (J1708, J1939, and J1850).
• Printed user’s manual and laminated Job Aid Card.
• Adobe Acrobat® 5.0 bundled on the CD for reading the Troubleshooting Manual.
• Microsoft® Media Player® 6.4 and 7.0 bundled on the CD for displaying various and updated training
videos (available from the application Help menu).
PC Platform Definition
Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool has been tested with and is known to operate on PCs with the following
configurations*:
• Microsoft Windows 95®, Windows NT® (SP3 or higher), Windows 2000®, Windows ME®, and
Windows XP®.
• 100 MB for free hard disk space required without the training videos. Additional 500 MB of hard drive
space is required if the user wishes to load the training videos. Videos can also be viewed directly from
the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool installation CD.
• 64 MB of RAM (128 MB for optimal performance)
• Pentium II processor (Pentium® III processor for optimal performance)
• One available COM (serial) port and parallel port

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. J–1


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX J—DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER INFORMATION


• 1024 X 768 screen resolution
• 256 color palette
• Small font
• Windows™ Media Player® is provided on the Allison DOC™ For PC CD and is installed with the
application.
NOTE:
1. The Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool will not function correctly on PCs not meeting the above
listed definition and will not be supported.
2. PCCS does not support Windows®, NT®, or ME®.
3. PCCS is a separate, stand-alone software application.
The Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is the preferred diagnostic tool of Allison Transmission. Information
about translator device support, support information, essential tool status, and purchasing information is as
follows:

Translator Device Support


Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool software has been functionally tested with the following translator devices:

• MPSI MagiKey® (PDM), Driver version 3.2 (or later)


For availability contact:
NEXIQ Technologies (MPSI) SPX Corporation (Kent-Moore Service
6405 Nineteen Mile Road Solutions)
Sterling Heights, MI 48314-2115 28635 Mound Road
Phone 1-800-639-6774 Warren, MI 48092
Fax 1-810-731-3348 Phone 1-800-328-6657
www.mpsilink.com Fax 1-800-578-7375
www.toolsfortrucks.com

• Noregon Systems Data Link Adapter (DLA)


For availability contact:
Noregon Systems
500 Shepherd Street
Winston-Salem, NC 27103
Phone 1-800-570-0571
Fax 1-336-760-2540
www.sales@Noregon.com
• Dearborn Group Dearborn protocol Adapter (DPA) II®, Driver version 2.3
NOTE: The DPA II translator device does not work with Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool installed in PCs
with Windows 95® operating systems.
For availability contact:
Dearborn Group Technology
27007 Hill Tech Court
Farmington Hills, MI 48331
Phone 1-248-488-2080
Fax 1-248-488-2082
www.dgtech.com

J–2 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX J—DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER INFORMATION

• B&B Electronics device will require the user to install an additional driver set found on the Allison
DOC™ For PC–Service Tool installation CD called “Noregon RP 1210A APL”
B&B Electronics
707 Dayton Road
Ottawa, IL 61350
Phone: 1-815-433-5100
Fax: 1-815-433-5104
www.vehicleinterface.com

• SPX Adapter J1850-VPW, P/N: J-44652, (for vehicles equipped with a J1850 communication link)
For availability contact:
SPX Corporation (Kent-Moore Service Solutions)
28635 Mound Road
Warren, MI 48092
Phone: 1-800-328-6657
Fax: 1-800-578-7375

PC Platform Definition
Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool has been tested with and is known to operate on PCs with the following
configurations:
• Microsoft® Windows 95®, Windows 98®, Windows NT® (SP3 or higher), Windows 2000®,
Windows ME®, and Windows XP®.
• 100 MB of free hard disk space required without the training videos. An additional 500 MB of hard
drive space is required to load the training videos. Videos can also be viewed directly from the Allison
DOC™ For PC–Service Tool installation CD.
• 64 MB of RAM (128 MB for optimal performance).
• Pentium II processor (Pentium III processor for optimal performance) One available COM (serial) port
and parallel port
• 1024 X 768 screen resolution
• 256 color palette
• Small font
• Windows™ Media Player® is provided on the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool CD and is installed
with the application.
NOTE:
• The Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool will not function correctly on PCs that do not meet the
above listed definition and will not be supported.
• PCCS (Production Calibration Configuration System) does not support Windows™, NT®, ME®
when recalibrating 3000 and 4000 Product Families transmissions.
• PCCS is a separate, stand-alone software application.

Support Information
Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is shipped with:
• Allison publication GN3433EN, User Guide
• Extensive updated Help menu (within the software)
• Updated-laminated tri-fold Job Aid Card, JA3434EN.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. J–3


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX J—DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER INFORMATION


All of these sources of information will provide you with the necessary guidelines to:
• Install
• Utilize
• Manipulate the software application.
The Technical Support Help Desk is available to register owners of Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool and to
address issues related to the installation of the application and connectivity to a vehicle. For PC or operating system
problems, please contact your company information technology department or refer to the documentation provided
with your PC.

Please check the Allison website, www.allisontransmission.com/service/allisontransmissiondiagnostictools,


regularly for important information that could clarify some of the common questions/concerns with respect to the
different Allison Transmission diagnostic tools.

Essential Tool Status


Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool has been classified as an ESSENTIAL TOOL for facilities authorized as 5610,
6610, 8610, 9610, 9805, and 9810 Series transmission maintenance or overhaul service outlets. Service outlets
currently enrolled in the Essential Tool program have received the traditional Essential Tool notification letter.
Reprogramming Requirements
Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool incorporates a reprogramming function, which allows modification of certain
transmission control systems (WTEC) values. The Allison Transmission Diagnostic Tool Service Training program
or equivalent, has to be completed in order to activate the reprogramming capabilities. Appropriate proof of
certification must be submitted to SPX/Kent-Moore (along with the serial number provided with the installation CD
package) to receive the corresponding authorization password, which will activate the reprogramming function of
the Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool. To learn more about course availability, please contact the local Allison
Transmission distributor training facility or visit Allison Transmission website at www.allisontransmission.com/
service/training.
Purchasing Information
Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is available on CD only and can be purchased through SPX/Kent-Moore using
the following part number:

User Part Number


New User J-44950-C
Current registered owners of Allison DOC™ For PC J-44950-UPD2
NOTE:
• Registered owners of Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool Do Not have to uninstall the application
in order to install Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool.
• Registered owners of Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool who had previously enabled the
Reprogramming function must re-authorize this function in Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool
with SPX/Kent-Moore.
For more information (price and availability), please contact:
SPX Corporation (Kent-Moore Service Solutions)
28635 Mound Road
Warren, MI 48092
Phone: 1-800-328-6657
Fax: 1-800-578-7375

J–4 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX J—DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER INFORMATION

J–2. PRO-LINK® 9000 DIAGNOSTIC TOOLS


NOTE: Allison DOC™ For PC–Service Tool is the preferred Allison Transmission diagnostic tool.
Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool will provide limited support.
Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool is available through NEXIQ. It is a portable microcomputer-based receiver/
transmitter/display unit. Pro-Link® 9000 transmits and receives data to and from the ECU, processes the data, and
displays appropriate information. Use Pro-Link® 9000 during installation checkout and troubleshooting. There is a
new Pro-Link® 9000 cartridge needed for use with CEC2. The new Multi-Protocol Cartridge (MPC) contains a
programmed PCMCIA card which permits reprogramming of GPI/GPO packages. Reprogramming includes
selection of a GPI/GPO package, enabling/disabling of wires and modification of certain data parameters.
Operating instructions are supplied with each Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool and further information is also
available in the Product section below. Connect the Pro-Link® 9000 diagnostic tool to the diagnostic connector
provided in the selector wiring harness.
The CEC2 system will require new Pro-Link® 9000 hardware for reprogramming and diagnostics. The following is
a list of manufacturer’s description and part numbers for current Pro-Link® 9000 hardware:
Product Part Number
Allison CEC1 and 2 transmission systems reprogramming card* 804007
Includes: Allison CEC 1 and 2 systems card and manual
* Allison training certificate required
Allison CEC1 and 2 transmission systems diagnostic card 804009
Includes: Allison CEC 1 and 2 systems card and manual
Pro-Link® Plus main unit 108004
Includes: VT Pro-Link® software, power and data cable, and storage case
Multi-Protocol Cartridge (MPC) 208040
Supports: J1708, J1939, 160 baud, and ISO 9141 communications,
OEM specific application memory cards
Printer 178001
Includes: One roll of thermal paper, Instruction manual, rechargeable battery
and a cable to connect
the printer to the Pro-Link® Plus
6-Pin Deutsch Adapter 404024
PC/Terminal Cable Set 501005
Required to update PC card application
Pro-Link® 9000 Operator’s Manual on CD 854049
NOTE:The new MPC must be used to reprogram CEC2 systems.

The Pro-Link® 9000 Diagnostic tool is available through:


NEXIQ
1-800-639-6774
Fax: 1-248-232-6611
The Multi-Protocol Cartridge (MPC) and the Reprogramming Card are required to modify customer constants and
alter calibration packages within the CEC2 ECU. After completing an Allison-approved training class, those
ordering a reprogramming cartridge are required to submit a copy of their completion certificate with their order.
This serves as proof of eligibility to purchase these items. Training is available from Allison Transmission (AT) and
AT distributors.

Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp. J–5


COMMERCIAL ELECTRONIC CONTROLS 2 (CEC2) TROUBLESHOOTING MANUAL

APPENDIX J—DIAGNOSTIC DATA READER INFORMATION

NOTES

J–6 Copyright © 2005 General Motors Corp.

You might also like